1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
764 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
794 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1890 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1891 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1892 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1893 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1894 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1897 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1898 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1906 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1909 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1912 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1914 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1918 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1921 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1925 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1927 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1931 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934 library and include files. For example:
1937 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1940 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1944 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1947 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1954 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1956 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1970 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1974 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1977 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1979 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1988 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1996 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2002 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2007 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008 .cindex "lookup modules"
2009 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2010 .cindex ".so building"
2011 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2014 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2017 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2019 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2026 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2037 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038 .cindex "build directory"
2039 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2047 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2056 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2062 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2072 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074 given in addition to the short output.
2078 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2087 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2090 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2095 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101 and are often not needed.
2103 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2114 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2121 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133 containing the lines
2138 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2141 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2146 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2161 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2171 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181 syntax. For instance:
2184 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2186 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2191 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2197 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2200 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2208 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2211 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2215 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2218 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219 definition of all three of these variables into your
2220 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2223 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2228 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2235 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2242 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2244 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2253 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254 .cindex "building Eximon"
2255 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256 where the files that are involved are
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2265 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2275 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276 .cindex "installing Exim"
2277 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2290 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296 alternative files, no default is installed.
2298 .cindex "system aliases file"
2299 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305 and outputs a comment to the user.
2307 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2313 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2320 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2324 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2326 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330 but this usage is deprecated.
2332 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2339 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2347 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2352 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2354 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2360 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2362 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2366 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2369 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2373 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2375 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2377 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2381 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2386 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2393 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2399 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2409 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2411 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2417 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2426 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2428 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2430 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432 user agent. For example:
2434 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435 From: user@your.domain.example
2436 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437 Subject: Testing Exim
2439 This is a test message.
2442 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2446 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2453 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2455 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2461 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462 .cindex "lock files"
2463 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2476 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2483 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2490 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2504 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2512 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2517 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519 favourite user agent.
2521 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2530 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2545 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2549 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2551 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2557 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2559 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2561 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2571 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2582 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585 were present before any other options.
2586 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2588 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2604 .cindex "queue runner"
2605 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2609 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2619 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2627 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2634 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2635 .cindex "envelope from"
2636 .cindex "envelope sender"
2637 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641 users to set envelope senders.
2643 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2651 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656 that are available to trusted users.
2658 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2664 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2669 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2674 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2680 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2688 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700 . creates a man page for the options.
2701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2704 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2711 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2717 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2718 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2722 .vitem &%--version%&
2723 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2724 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2731 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2734 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2736 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2737 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739 clean; it ignores this option.
2744 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745 .cindex "queue runner"
2746 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2750 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2755 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2760 When a listening daemon
2761 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2769 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2775 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780 .cindex reload configuration
2781 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786 because these are reread each time they are used.
2790 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2795 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2802 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806 test data. A line history is supported.
2808 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2816 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2821 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822 defined and macros will be expanded.
2823 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824 available to admin users.
2826 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2828 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831 of a file. For example:
2833 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2835 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2844 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2846 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850 system filters are recognized.
2852 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2854 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2855 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2864 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2868 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2870 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871 variables that are used by the user filter.
2873 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2878 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2883 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2888 When testing a filter file,
2889 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2890 .cindex "envelope from"
2891 .cindex "envelope sender"
2892 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2899 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2901 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2906 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2908 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912 actually being delivered.
2914 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2916 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2917 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2921 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2923 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2924 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2928 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2930 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938 after a full stop. For example:
2940 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2943 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945 conversion to the canonical form is
2946 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2948 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2956 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2961 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2965 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970 session were authenticated.
2972 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2976 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978 specialized SMTP test program such as
2979 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2981 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2983 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985 updating the callout cache database.
2989 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2990 .cindex "building alias file"
2991 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2998 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3006 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3008 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009 .cindex "querying exim information"
3010 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3017 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020 recognised DSCP names.
3022 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030 way to guarantee a correct response.
3034 .cindex "local message reception"
3035 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040 if no other conflicting option is present.
3042 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045 suppressing this for special cases.
3047 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3050 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3055 .cindex "message" "format"
3056 .cindex "format" "message"
3057 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3058 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3063 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3066 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3072 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3078 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3081 .cindex "malware scan test"
3082 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3084 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3090 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093 This option requires admin privileges.
3095 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3101 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3109 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3115 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3123 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128 arguments, for example:
3130 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3132 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137 users, the output is as in this example:
3139 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3141 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3144 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146 backward compatibility.)
3147 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3150 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152 name will not be output.
3154 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160 written directly into the spool directory.
3162 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3164 exim -bP +local_domains
3166 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3169 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174 that driver are output. For example:
3176 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3178 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3185 .cindex "environment"
3186 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3190 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194 The output format is one item per line.
3195 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196 the exit status will be nonzero.
3200 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206 to allow any user to see the queue.
3208 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3210 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3214 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215 .cindex "size" "of message"
3216 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222 before the sender address.
3224 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3228 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3238 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3246 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3254 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3265 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3270 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3278 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3284 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3287 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3297 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3303 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3313 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3323 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3327 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3332 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3336 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3342 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3347 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3349 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353 messages to the MTA.
3356 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3357 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3366 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372 the listening daemon.
3376 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377 .cindex "address" "testing"
3378 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3384 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3387 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3391 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3398 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3403 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3409 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3412 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3422 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3423 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3429 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435 dynamic testing facilities.
3439 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440 .cindex "address" "verification"
3441 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3448 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3452 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3455 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3459 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3465 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3473 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3478 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3483 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3490 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3498 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3503 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506 each port only when the first connection is received.
3508 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3511 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3513 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3523 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3533 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3541 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3549 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3554 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558 specified by this option.
3561 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3563 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3570 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3578 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3586 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3590 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3592 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3596 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3598 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3607 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3616 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617 &`auth `& authenticators
3618 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623 &`filter `& filter handling
3624 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626 &`ident `& ident lookup
3627 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3629 &`load `& system load checks
3630 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633 &`memory `& memory handling
3634 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3638 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3639 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640 &`retry `& retry handling
3641 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642 &`route `& address routing
3643 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3645 &`transport `& transports
3646 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647 &`verify `& address verification logic
3648 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3650 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655 turn everything off.
3657 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3664 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3671 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3675 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3682 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3685 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3687 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3693 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3700 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3710 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3716 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3718 .cindex "sender" "name"
3719 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3720 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3726 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3728 .cindex "sender" "address"
3729 .cindex "address" "sender"
3730 .cindex "trusted users"
3731 .cindex "envelope from"
3732 .cindex "envelope sender"
3733 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3734 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3739 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3745 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749 examples of shell commands:
3751 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752 exim -f "" user@domain
3754 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3758 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3764 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3765 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3773 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3776 control = suppress_local_fixups
3778 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3782 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3785 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3787 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3794 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3801 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3803 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3810 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3812 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3814 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3815 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3823 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3830 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3835 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3837 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843 can be used only by an admin user.
3845 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3848 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3859 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3865 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3869 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3871 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3877 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3883 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3887 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3889 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3898 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3905 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3909 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3911 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3916 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3918 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3932 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3934 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3936 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3943 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3945 .cindex "freezing messages"
3946 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3954 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3956 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3957 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3967 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3970 .cindex "named queues"
3971 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3972 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3973 queue to the given named queue.
3974 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3975 string to define the default queue.
3976 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3977 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3980 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3982 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3983 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3984 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3985 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3986 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3988 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3990 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3991 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3992 .cindex "removing recipients"
3993 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3994 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3995 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3996 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3997 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3998 can be used only by an admin user.
4000 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4002 .cindex "removing messages"
4003 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4004 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4005 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4006 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4007 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4008 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4009 placed in the queue.
4014 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4015 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4016 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4020 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4022 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4023 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4024 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4025 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4026 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4027 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4028 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4029 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4030 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4032 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4034 .cindex "thawing messages"
4035 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4036 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4037 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4038 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4039 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4040 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4043 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4045 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4046 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4047 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4048 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4050 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4052 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4053 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4054 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4055 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4056 only by an admin user.
4058 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4060 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4061 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4062 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4063 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4064 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4066 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4068 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4069 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4070 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4071 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4075 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4076 treats it that way too.
4080 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4081 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4082 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4083 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4084 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4085 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4086 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4089 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4090 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4091 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4092 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4093 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4094 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4095 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4100 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4101 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4102 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4103 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4105 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4107 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4110 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4112 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4113 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4114 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4117 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4119 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4120 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4121 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4122 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4123 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4124 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4128 .cindex "background delivery"
4129 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4130 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4131 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4132 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4133 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4134 processes to finish.
4136 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4137 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4138 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4139 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4141 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4142 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4143 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4144 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4148 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4149 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4150 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4151 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4152 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4153 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4155 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4156 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4159 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4160 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4162 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4163 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4164 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4165 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4170 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4175 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4176 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4177 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4178 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4179 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4180 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4181 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4182 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4183 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4184 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4189 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4190 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4191 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4192 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4193 configuration file is in effect.
4195 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4196 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4197 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4198 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4199 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4200 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4201 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4202 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4203 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4208 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4209 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4210 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4213 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4215 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4216 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4217 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4218 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4222 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4223 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4224 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4225 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4226 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4230 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4231 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4232 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4233 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4234 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4238 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4239 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4244 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4245 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4250 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4251 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4252 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4253 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4254 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4255 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4258 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4259 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4261 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4263 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4264 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4265 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4266 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4267 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4268 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4270 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4271 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4273 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4275 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4276 followed by a colon and the port number:
4278 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4280 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4281 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4282 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4283 whichever one is last.
4285 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4287 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4289 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4290 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4291 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4292 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4294 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4296 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4297 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4298 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4299 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4300 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4301 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4303 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4305 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4306 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4307 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4308 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4309 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4310 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4311 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4312 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4314 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4316 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4317 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4318 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4319 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4320 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4322 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4324 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4325 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4326 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4327 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4328 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4329 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4330 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4332 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4333 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4334 is sending the bounce.
4336 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4338 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4339 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4340 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4341 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4342 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4343 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4344 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4345 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4346 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4347 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4349 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4351 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4352 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4353 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4354 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4355 uses the name it is given.
4357 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4359 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4360 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4361 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4362 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4363 used, when there is no default.
4367 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4368 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4369 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4370 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4374 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4375 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4376 whatever that means.
4378 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4380 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4381 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4382 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4383 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4384 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4385 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4386 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4388 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4390 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4391 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4392 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4393 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4394 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4396 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4398 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4399 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4400 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4401 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4402 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4403 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4407 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4409 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4411 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4412 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4413 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4414 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4415 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4416 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4417 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4418 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4422 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4423 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4424 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4425 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4430 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4431 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4432 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4433 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4436 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4438 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4440 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4442 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4443 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4444 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4445 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4446 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4447 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4451 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4452 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4453 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4454 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4455 and &%-S%& options).
4457 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4458 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4459 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4460 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4461 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4462 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4463 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4466 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4467 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4468 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4469 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4470 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4473 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4474 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4475 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4476 this to be repeated periodically.
4478 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4479 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4480 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4481 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4483 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4484 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4485 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4487 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4488 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4489 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4490 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4494 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4495 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4496 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4497 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4498 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4499 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4502 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4503 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4504 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4505 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4506 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4507 delivered down a single SMTP
4508 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4509 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4510 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4511 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4512 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4515 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4517 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4518 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4519 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4520 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4521 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4523 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4525 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4526 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4527 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4528 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4529 their retry times are tried.
4531 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4533 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4534 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4537 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4539 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4540 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4541 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4544 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4547 .cindex "named queues"
4548 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4549 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4550 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4551 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4552 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4553 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4555 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4556 will specify a queue to operate on.
4559 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4561 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4564 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4565 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4566 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4567 starting message id. For example:
4569 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4571 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4572 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4573 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4575 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4577 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4578 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4579 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4580 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4581 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4582 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4584 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4585 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4586 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4587 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4588 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4589 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4590 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4591 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4592 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4594 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4596 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4597 process every 30 minutes.
4599 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4600 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4602 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4604 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4607 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4609 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4611 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4613 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4614 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4615 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4616 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4617 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4618 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4619 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4621 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4622 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4623 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4624 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4625 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4626 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4628 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4629 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4631 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4633 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4634 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4635 applied to each queue run.
4637 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4638 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4639 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4640 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4641 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4642 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4643 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4644 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4645 address will be skipped.
4647 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4648 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4649 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4652 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4653 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4654 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4655 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4656 an arbitrary command instead.
4660 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4662 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4664 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4665 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4666 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4667 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4668 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4669 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4671 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4673 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4674 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4675 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4679 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4680 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4681 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4682 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4683 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4684 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4685 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4686 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4687 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4689 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4690 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4691 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4692 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4693 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4694 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4695 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4696 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4697 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4698 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4699 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4701 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4702 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4703 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4704 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4705 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4706 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4708 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4709 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4710 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4711 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4712 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4713 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4714 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4715 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4716 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4720 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4721 compatibility with Sendmail.
4723 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4724 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4725 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4726 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4727 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4728 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4729 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4730 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4735 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4736 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4737 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4738 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4739 set. Exim ignores this option.
4743 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4744 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4745 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4746 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4747 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4748 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4753 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4754 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4755 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4758 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4760 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4761 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4763 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4765 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4766 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4767 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4776 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4777 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4778 . creates a man page for the options.
4779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4782 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4793 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4794 "The runtime configuration file"
4796 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4797 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4798 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4799 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4800 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4801 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4802 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4803 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4804 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4807 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4808 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4809 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4810 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4811 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4812 actually alter the string.
4814 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4815 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4816 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4817 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4818 existing file in the list.
4821 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4822 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4823 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4824 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4825 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4826 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4827 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4828 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4829 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4830 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4832 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4833 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4834 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4835 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4836 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4838 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4839 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4840 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4841 compromise the Exim user account.
4843 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4844 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4845 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4846 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4847 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4848 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4853 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4855 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4856 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4857 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4858 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4859 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4860 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4861 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4862 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4863 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4865 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4866 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4867 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4868 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4869 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4870 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4871 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4872 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4873 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4876 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4877 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4878 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4879 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4880 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4882 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4883 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4884 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4885 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4886 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4887 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4889 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4890 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4891 necessarily be discarded.
4892 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4893 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4894 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4895 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4896 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4897 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4899 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4900 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4901 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4902 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4903 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4904 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4905 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4907 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4908 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4909 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4913 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4914 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4915 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4916 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4917 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4918 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4919 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4920 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4923 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4926 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4927 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4928 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4930 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4931 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4932 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4934 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4935 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4936 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4938 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4939 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4940 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4941 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4944 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4945 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4946 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4948 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4949 want to use this feature, you must set
4951 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4953 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4954 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4957 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4958 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4959 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4960 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4962 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4963 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4964 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4965 and does not introduce a comment.
4967 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4968 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4969 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4970 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4971 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4973 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4974 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4975 change settings as required.
4977 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4978 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4979 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4980 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4981 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4986 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4987 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4988 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4989 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4990 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4991 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4994 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4995 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4997 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4998 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4999 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5000 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5001 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5004 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5005 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5006 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5007 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5009 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5010 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5013 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5016 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5017 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5022 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5023 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5024 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5025 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5026 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5027 definition, and must be of the form
5029 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5031 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5032 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5033 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5034 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5035 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5037 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5038 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5039 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5041 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5042 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5043 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5044 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5045 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5046 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5047 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5050 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5051 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5053 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5054 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5055 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5056 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5057 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5058 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5061 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5062 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5063 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5068 MAC == updated value
5070 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5071 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5072 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5073 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5077 MAC == MAC and something added
5079 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5080 from a number of other files.
5082 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5083 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5084 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5085 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5086 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5091 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5092 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5093 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5094 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5096 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5097 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5099 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5101 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5103 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5104 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5105 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5108 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5109 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5110 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5111 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5112 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5115 The following classes of macros are defined:
5117 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5118 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5119 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5120 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5121 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5122 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5123 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5124 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5125 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5126 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5127 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5128 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5131 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5134 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5135 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5136 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5137 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5138 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5139 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5140 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5142 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5143 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5144 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5148 message_size_limit = 50M
5150 message_size_limit = 100M
5153 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5154 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5155 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5156 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5157 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5159 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5160 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5161 in this line"& will always be true.
5163 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5164 to clarify complicated nestings.
5168 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5169 .cindex "common option syntax"
5170 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5171 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5172 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5173 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5174 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5175 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5176 space) and then the value. For example:
5178 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5180 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5181 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5182 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5183 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5184 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5185 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5186 word &"hide"&. For example:
5188 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5190 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5192 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5194 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5195 all instances of the same driver.
5197 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5198 that are found in option settings.
5201 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5202 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5203 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5204 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5205 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5206 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5207 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5208 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5209 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5210 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5211 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5212 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5217 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5222 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5227 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5228 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5229 .cindex "format" "integer"
5230 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5231 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5232 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5233 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5236 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5237 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5238 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5240 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5241 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5242 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5246 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5247 .cindex "integer format"
5248 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5249 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5250 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5251 Such options are always output in octal.
5254 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5255 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5256 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5257 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5258 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5262 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5263 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5264 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5265 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5266 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5276 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5277 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5278 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5282 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5283 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5284 .cindex "format" "string"
5285 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5286 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5287 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5288 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5289 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5290 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5291 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5292 therefore equivalent:
5294 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5295 trusted_users = uucp:\
5296 # This comment line is ignored
5299 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5300 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5301 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5302 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5303 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5306 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5307 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5308 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5310 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5311 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5315 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5316 character, that character replaces the pair.
5318 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5319 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5320 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5321 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5322 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5323 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5326 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5327 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5328 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5329 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5330 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5331 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5332 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5333 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5334 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5335 within a quoted configuration string.
5338 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5339 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5340 .cindex "format" "user name"
5341 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5342 .cindex "format" "group name"
5343 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5344 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5345 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5346 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5349 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5350 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5351 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5352 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5353 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5354 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5355 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5356 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5357 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5358 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5359 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5361 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5362 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5363 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5364 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5365 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5366 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5369 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5371 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5373 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5374 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5375 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5376 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5378 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5379 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5380 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5381 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5382 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5383 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5384 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5385 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5387 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5389 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5390 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5391 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5393 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5394 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5395 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5396 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5397 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5398 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5399 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5400 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5401 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5403 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5405 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5406 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5407 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5408 the value in quotes. For example:
5410 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5412 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5413 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5414 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5415 enclosing an empty list item.
5419 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5420 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5421 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5422 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5424 senders = user@domain :
5426 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5427 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5428 items, the second of which is empty:
5430 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5432 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5433 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5434 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5435 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5439 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5440 is at the end of the list.
5445 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5446 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5447 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5448 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5449 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5450 a sequence of lines like this:
5452 <&'instance name'&>:
5457 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5458 followed by three options settings:
5463 transport = local_delivery
5465 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5466 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5467 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5468 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5469 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5470 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5472 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5473 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5475 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5476 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5477 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5478 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5479 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5482 .cindex "generic options"
5483 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5484 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5485 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5486 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5487 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5488 .cindex "private options"
5489 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5490 they all have default values.
5492 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5493 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5494 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5496 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5497 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5498 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5499 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5500 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5501 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5502 configuration lines:
5507 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5508 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5509 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5510 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5516 command_timeout = 10s
5518 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5519 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5522 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5523 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5524 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5535 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5536 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5537 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5538 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5539 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5540 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5541 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5542 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5543 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5544 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5545 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5549 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5550 All macros should be defined before any options.
5552 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5554 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5556 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5557 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5558 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5559 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5561 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5562 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5563 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5566 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5567 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5568 in the file, after the macros.
5569 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5571 # primary_hostname =
5573 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5574 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5575 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5576 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5578 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5580 domainlist local_domains = @
5581 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5582 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5584 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5585 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5586 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5587 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5589 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5590 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5593 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5594 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5595 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5596 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5597 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5598 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5600 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5601 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5602 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5603 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5604 domain is permitted.
5606 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5607 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5608 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5609 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5610 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5611 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5613 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5614 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5615 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5617 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5619 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5620 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5622 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5623 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5624 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5625 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5626 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5627 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5628 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5629 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5630 contents of a message to be checked.
5632 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5634 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5635 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5637 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5638 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5639 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5640 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5642 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5644 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5645 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5646 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5648 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5649 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5650 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5651 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5652 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5653 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5654 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5656 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5658 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5659 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5661 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5662 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5663 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5664 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5665 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5666 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5667 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5668 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5669 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5670 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5671 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5672 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5673 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5674 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5675 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5676 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5678 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5679 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5680 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5681 which should be used in preference to 587.
5682 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5684 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5686 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5689 # qualify_recipient =
5691 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5692 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5693 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5694 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5695 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5696 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5698 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5699 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5700 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5701 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5703 # allow_domain_literals
5705 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5706 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5707 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5708 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5709 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5710 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5712 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5716 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5717 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5718 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5719 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5720 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5721 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5722 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5723 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5725 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5726 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5731 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5732 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5733 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5734 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5735 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5736 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5739 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5740 1413 (hence their names):
5743 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5745 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5746 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5747 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5748 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5749 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5750 information, you can change this.
5752 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5753 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5758 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5759 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5760 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5761 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5763 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5764 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5766 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5767 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5769 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5772 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5773 +tls_certificate_verified
5776 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5778 # percent_hack_domains =
5780 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5781 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5782 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5784 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5785 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5786 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5787 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5788 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5789 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5790 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5791 always bounce messages.
5793 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5794 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5796 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5797 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5798 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5799 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5800 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5802 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5803 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5804 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5805 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5806 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5809 # split_spool_directory = true
5812 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5813 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5814 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5815 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5816 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5817 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5818 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5820 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5823 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5824 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5825 that are not 8-bit clean.
5827 # accept_8bitmime = false
5830 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5831 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5832 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5833 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5834 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5835 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5837 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5838 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5842 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5843 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5844 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5845 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5846 It starts with the line
5850 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5851 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5852 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5854 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5855 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5856 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5857 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5858 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5859 result of the ACL processing.
5863 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5868 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5869 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5870 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5871 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5872 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5873 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5875 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5876 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5877 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5880 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5881 domains = +local_domains
5882 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5884 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5885 domains = !+local_domains
5886 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5888 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5889 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5890 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5891 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5892 in Internet mail addresses.
5894 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5895 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5896 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5897 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5898 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5899 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5900 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5901 policy of being as safe as possible.
5903 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5904 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5905 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5906 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5907 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5908 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5910 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5911 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5912 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5913 have to modify this rule.
5915 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5916 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5917 common convention of local parts constructed as
5918 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5919 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5920 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5921 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5922 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5923 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5925 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5926 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5927 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5928 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5929 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5930 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5931 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5933 accept local_parts = postmaster
5934 domains = +local_domains
5936 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5937 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5938 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5939 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5940 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5942 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5943 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5944 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5946 require verify = sender
5948 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5949 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5950 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5951 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5952 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5953 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5954 discusses the details of address verification.
5956 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5957 control = submission
5959 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5960 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5961 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5962 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5963 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5964 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5965 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5966 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5967 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5969 accept authenticated = *
5970 control = submission
5972 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5973 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5974 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5975 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5976 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5977 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5979 require message = relay not permitted
5980 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5982 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5983 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5985 require verify = recipient
5987 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5988 fails, the address is rejected.
5990 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5991 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5993 # dnslists = black.list.example
5995 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5996 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5997 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5998 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6000 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6001 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6002 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6005 # require verify = csa
6007 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6008 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6013 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6014 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6018 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6019 of this ACL are commented out:
6022 # message = This message contains a virus \
6025 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6026 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6027 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6028 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6030 # warn spam = nobody
6031 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6032 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6033 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6034 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6036 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6037 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6038 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6039 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6040 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6041 whatever the spam score.
6045 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6048 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6049 .cindex "default" "routers"
6050 .cindex "routers" "default"
6051 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6056 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6057 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6058 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6059 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6060 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6063 # driver = ipliteral
6064 # domains = !+local_domains
6065 # transport = remote_smtp
6067 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6068 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6069 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6070 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6071 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6073 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6074 macro has been defined, per
6076 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6085 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6086 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6087 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6088 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6092 driver = manualroute
6093 domains = ! +local_domains
6094 transport = smarthost_smtp
6095 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6096 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6099 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6100 specified by the line
6102 domains = ! +local_domains
6104 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6105 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6106 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6107 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6108 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6109 passed on to the following routers.
6111 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6112 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6113 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6114 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6116 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6117 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6118 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6119 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6120 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6121 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6122 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6127 domains = ! +local_domains
6128 transport = remote_smtp
6129 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6132 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6134 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6135 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6136 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6137 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6138 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6140 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6141 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6142 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6143 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6144 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6145 the address fails and is bounced.
6147 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6148 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6149 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6150 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6151 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6152 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6153 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6160 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6162 file_transport = address_file
6163 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6165 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6166 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6167 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6168 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6169 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6172 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6173 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6174 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6175 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6180 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6181 # local_part_suffix_optional
6182 file = $home/.forward
6187 file_transport = address_file
6188 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6189 reply_transport = address_reply
6191 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6192 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6193 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6194 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6195 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6198 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6199 # local_part_suffix_optional
6201 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6202 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6203 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6204 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6205 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6206 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6207 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6209 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6210 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6211 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6212 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6214 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6215 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6216 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6217 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6218 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6219 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6220 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6222 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6223 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6224 There are two reasons for doing this:
6227 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6228 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6231 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6232 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6233 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6234 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6238 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6239 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6240 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6241 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6243 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6244 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6245 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6247 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6249 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6255 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6256 # local_part_suffix_optional
6257 transport = local_delivery
6259 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6260 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6261 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6262 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6263 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6266 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6267 .cindex "default" "transports"
6268 .cindex "transports" "default"
6269 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6270 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6271 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6275 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6279 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6284 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6285 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6286 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6287 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6288 to use DANE for delivery;
6289 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6291 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6292 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6293 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6294 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6296 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6297 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6298 usual federated system.
6303 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6307 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6308 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6309 hosts_require_tls = *
6310 tls_verify_hosts = *
6311 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6312 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6314 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6316 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6317 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6318 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6319 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6320 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6321 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6323 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6324 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6327 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6334 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6335 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6336 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6337 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6338 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6339 then no other options are defined.
6340 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6341 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6342 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6343 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6344 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6345 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6346 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6347 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6348 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6349 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6350 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6352 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6354 All other options are defaulted.
6358 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6365 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6366 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6367 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6368 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6369 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6370 show how this can be done.
6372 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6373 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6374 similarly-named options above.
6380 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6381 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6382 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6383 be returned to the sender.
6391 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6392 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6393 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6398 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6403 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6404 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6405 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6406 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6407 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6408 introduced by the line
6412 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6415 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6417 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6418 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6419 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6420 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6421 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6423 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6424 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6425 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6428 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6429 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6433 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6434 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6438 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6439 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6440 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6442 begin authenticators
6444 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6445 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6446 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6447 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6448 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6449 to support most MUA software.
6451 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6454 # driver = plaintext
6455 # server_set_id = $auth2
6456 # server_prompts = :
6457 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6458 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6460 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6463 # driver = plaintext
6464 # server_set_id = $auth1
6465 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6466 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6467 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6470 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6471 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6472 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6473 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6474 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6475 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6476 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6477 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6479 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6480 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6481 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6482 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6484 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6485 usercode and password are in different positions.
6486 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6488 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6495 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6497 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6499 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6500 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6501 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6502 regular expressions is discussed in
6503 online Perl manpages, in
6504 many Perl reference books, and also in
6505 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6506 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6507 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6508 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6509 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6511 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6512 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6513 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6514 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6515 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6518 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6519 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6520 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6521 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6523 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6525 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6526 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6527 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6528 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6529 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6530 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6533 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6534 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6535 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6536 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6537 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6538 match anywhere in the subject string.
6540 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6541 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6543 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6545 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6548 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6550 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6551 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6558 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6559 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6560 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6561 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6562 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6563 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6566 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6567 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6568 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6569 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6570 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6571 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6573 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6574 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6575 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6576 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6577 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6578 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6581 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6582 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6583 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6584 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6585 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6586 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6588 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6589 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6590 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6591 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6592 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6594 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6595 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6597 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6598 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6599 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6600 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6601 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6603 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6604 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6606 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6607 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6609 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6610 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6611 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6616 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6617 matches the list item.
6619 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6620 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6622 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6624 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6625 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6626 causes a second lookup to occur.
6628 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6629 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6630 lookup is permitted.
6633 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6634 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6635 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6636 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6639 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6640 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6641 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6643 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6644 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6645 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6646 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6649 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6650 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6651 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6656 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6657 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6658 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6663 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6664 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6665 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6666 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6669 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6670 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6671 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6672 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6673 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6674 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6675 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6676 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6677 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6679 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6680 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6681 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6682 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6684 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6685 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6686 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6687 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6689 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6691 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6692 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6693 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6694 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6695 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6697 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6698 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6699 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6700 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6701 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6702 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6703 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6705 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6706 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6708 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6709 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6710 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6711 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6712 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6713 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6714 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6716 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6717 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6718 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6720 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6721 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6722 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6723 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6724 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6725 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6726 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6727 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6728 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6729 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6731 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6732 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6733 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6734 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6735 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6736 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6737 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6738 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6739 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6741 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6742 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6743 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6744 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6745 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6746 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6747 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6749 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6750 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6751 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6752 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6754 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6755 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6756 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6757 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6758 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6760 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6761 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6762 lookup types support only literal keys.
6764 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6765 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6766 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6769 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6770 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6771 notation before executing the lookup.)
6776 .cindex json "lookup type"
6777 .cindex JSON expansions
6778 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6779 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6780 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6781 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6782 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6783 of the JSON structure.
6784 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6785 nunbered array element is selected.
6786 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6787 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6788 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6790 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6793 .cindex "linear search"
6794 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6795 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6796 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6797 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6798 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6799 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6800 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6801 in the file is used.
6803 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6804 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6805 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6806 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6807 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6812 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6813 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6814 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6815 wildcarding of any kind.
6817 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6818 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6819 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6820 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6821 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6822 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6823 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6824 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6825 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6828 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6829 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6830 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6831 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6832 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6833 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6834 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6835 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6838 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6839 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6840 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6842 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6843 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6844 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6845 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6846 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6848 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6849 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6850 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6851 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6853 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6854 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6857 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6859 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6860 *fish data for anythingfish
6863 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6864 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6866 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6868 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6869 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6870 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6872 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6874 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6875 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6876 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6878 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6881 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6882 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6883 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6884 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6885 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6887 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6888 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6889 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6890 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6891 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6894 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6895 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6896 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6899 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6901 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6904 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6905 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6906 be followed by optional colons.
6908 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6909 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6910 lookup types support only literal keys.
6913 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6914 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6915 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6916 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6920 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6921 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6922 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6923 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6924 many of them are given in later sections.
6927 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6928 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6929 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6930 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6931 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6933 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6934 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6935 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6937 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6938 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6939 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6940 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6941 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6942 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6943 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6945 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6946 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6947 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6948 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6950 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6951 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6952 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6953 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6955 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6956 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6957 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6958 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6960 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6961 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6962 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6963 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6964 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6965 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6966 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6967 password value. For example:
6969 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6972 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6973 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6974 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6975 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6978 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6979 .cindex lookup Redis
6980 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6981 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6984 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6985 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6986 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6987 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6990 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6991 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6993 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6994 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6995 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6996 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6997 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6998 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6999 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7000 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7001 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7002 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7004 require condition = \
7005 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7007 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7008 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7009 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7010 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7015 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7016 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7017 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7018 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7019 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7020 options such as a list of local domains.
7022 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7023 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7024 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7025 or may give up altogether.
7029 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7030 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7031 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7032 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7033 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7034 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7035 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7036 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7038 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7039 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7040 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7042 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7043 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7044 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7046 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7047 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7048 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7049 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7050 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7051 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7052 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7053 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7054 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7055 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7057 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7059 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7060 looks up these keys, in this order:
7066 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7067 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7068 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7069 Exim move on to try the next key.
7073 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7074 .cindex "partial matching"
7075 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7076 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7077 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7078 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7079 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7080 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7081 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7082 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7083 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7084 a key in a DBM file is
7086 *.dates.fict.example
7088 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7089 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7090 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7093 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7094 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7095 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7097 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7098 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7099 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7100 partial matching keys
7101 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7102 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7103 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7105 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7106 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7107 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7108 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7109 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7110 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7113 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7114 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7115 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7116 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7117 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7118 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7120 2250.dates.fict.example
7121 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7122 *.dates.fict.example
7125 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7128 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7129 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7130 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7131 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7132 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7133 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7135 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7137 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7138 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7139 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7140 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7142 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7144 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7145 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7147 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7148 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7149 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7152 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7154 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7155 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7157 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7158 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7159 for &"*"& on its own.
7161 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7165 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7166 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7167 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7168 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7169 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7170 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7171 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7173 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7174 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7175 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7176 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7177 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7182 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7183 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7184 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7185 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7186 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7187 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7188 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7190 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7191 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7192 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7193 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7194 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7195 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7197 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7198 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7204 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7205 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7206 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7207 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7208 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7209 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7213 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7214 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7216 [name="$local_part"]
7218 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7219 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7220 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7221 of the following form is provided:
7223 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7225 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7227 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7229 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7230 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7231 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7236 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7237 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7238 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7239 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7240 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7241 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7242 an expansion string could contain:
7244 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7246 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7247 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7248 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7249 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7251 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7252 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7253 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7255 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7256 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7257 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7258 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7259 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7261 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7263 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7264 white space is ignored.
7265 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7266 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7267 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7269 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270 When the type is PTR,
7271 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7272 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7274 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7276 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7277 altered and nothing is added.
7279 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7280 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7281 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7282 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7283 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7284 The field separator can be modified as above.
7286 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7287 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7288 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7289 unless a field separator is specified.
7290 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7292 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7294 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7295 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7296 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7298 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7299 white space is ignored.
7301 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7302 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7303 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7304 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7307 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7310 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7311 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7312 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7313 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7314 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7315 each followed by a comma,
7316 that may appear before the record type.
7318 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7319 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7320 a defer-option modifier.
7321 The possible keywords are
7322 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7323 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7324 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7325 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7326 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7327 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7328 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7330 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7331 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7333 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7334 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7336 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7337 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7338 The possible keywords are
7339 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7340 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7342 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7343 is not labelled as authenticated data
7344 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7345 The default is &"lax"&.
7347 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7349 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7350 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7351 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7352 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7354 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7356 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7357 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7358 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7360 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7361 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7363 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7364 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7365 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7368 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7369 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7370 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7371 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7372 the pseudo-type MXH:
7374 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7376 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7379 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7380 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7381 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7382 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7383 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7384 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7385 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7386 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7388 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7389 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7391 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7392 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7393 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7395 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7396 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7397 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7398 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7399 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7402 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7403 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7404 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7405 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7406 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7407 result of a successful lookup such as:
7409 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7411 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7412 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7413 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7415 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7416 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7417 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7418 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7420 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7424 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7425 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7426 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7427 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7428 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7430 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7431 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7432 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7434 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7435 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7436 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7437 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7439 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7440 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7441 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7446 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7447 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7448 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7449 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7450 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7451 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7452 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7453 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7454 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7455 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7456 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7457 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7459 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7460 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7461 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7462 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7463 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7465 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7466 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7468 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7469 the way they handle the results of a query:
7472 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7475 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7476 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7478 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7479 from all of them are returned.
7483 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7484 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7485 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7486 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7489 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7490 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7491 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7492 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7494 data = ${lookup ldap \
7495 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7496 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7498 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7499 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7500 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7501 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7503 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7504 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7505 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7507 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7508 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7509 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7510 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7511 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7512 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7513 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7514 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7518 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7519 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7520 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7521 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7522 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7523 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7525 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7526 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7534 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7535 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7539 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7541 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7545 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7547 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7549 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7551 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7552 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7553 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7557 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7558 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7559 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7561 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7565 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7567 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7569 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7571 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7572 authentication below.
7575 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7576 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7577 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7578 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7579 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7582 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7584 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7585 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7586 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7587 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7588 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7589 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7590 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7591 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7592 failures, and timeouts.
7594 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7595 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7596 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7597 doubled. For example
7599 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7601 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7602 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7603 the local host) is used.
7605 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7606 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7607 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7608 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7611 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7612 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7613 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7614 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7616 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7618 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7619 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7621 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7623 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7624 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7625 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7626 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7627 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7628 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7629 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7632 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7633 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7634 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7637 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7640 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7644 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7645 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7649 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7650 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7651 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7652 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7653 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7654 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7655 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7656 them. The following names are recognized:
7658 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7659 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7660 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7661 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7662 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7663 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7664 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7665 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7667 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7668 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7669 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7670 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7672 .cindex LDAP timeout
7673 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7674 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7675 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7676 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7677 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7678 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7679 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7680 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7681 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7682 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7684 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7685 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7687 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7688 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7689 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7690 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7691 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7692 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7693 alternate list (colon-separated).
7695 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7696 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7699 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7700 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7703 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7704 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7705 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7706 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7708 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7709 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7710 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7712 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7713 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7714 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7715 quoting has two advantages:
7718 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7719 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7721 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7724 For example, a setting such as
7726 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7728 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7730 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7731 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7732 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7733 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7737 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7738 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7743 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7744 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7745 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7746 as a sequence of values, for example
7748 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7750 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7751 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7752 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7753 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7754 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7757 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7758 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7759 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7760 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7762 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7763 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7764 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7765 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7766 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7767 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7768 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7769 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7770 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7772 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7773 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7774 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7775 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7776 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7779 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7782 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7785 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7786 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7788 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7789 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7791 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7792 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7795 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7796 results of LDAP lookups.
7797 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7798 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7799 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7800 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7801 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7802 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7807 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7808 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7809 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7810 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7811 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7812 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7813 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7814 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7816 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7818 might return the string
7820 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7821 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7823 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7825 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7831 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7832 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7833 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7837 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7838 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7839 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7840 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7841 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7842 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7843 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7844 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7845 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7846 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7847 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7848 .cindex lookup Redis
7849 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7851 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7854 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7857 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7858 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7860 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7865 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7867 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7868 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7869 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7873 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7874 with a newline between the data for each row.
7877 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7878 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7879 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7880 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7881 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7882 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7883 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7884 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7885 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7886 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7887 .cindex lookup Redis
7888 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7889 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7890 or &%redis_servers%&
7891 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7893 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7894 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7895 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7897 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7898 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7899 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7900 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7902 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7904 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7905 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7906 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7908 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7909 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7911 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7912 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7913 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7914 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7915 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7916 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7918 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7919 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7920 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7922 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7923 host, database number, and password.
7925 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7926 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7927 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7929 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7931 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7934 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7935 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7936 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7937 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7939 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7940 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7942 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7943 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7944 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7945 done by starting the query with
7947 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7949 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7951 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7952 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7953 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7956 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7958 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7959 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7960 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7962 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7963 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7964 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7967 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7971 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7973 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7975 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7976 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7977 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7979 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7983 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7984 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7985 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7986 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7987 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7988 the default value is &"exim"&.
7989 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7991 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7992 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7994 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7995 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7997 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8000 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8001 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8003 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8004 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8005 is zero because no rows are affected.
8008 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8009 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8010 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8011 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8012 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8015 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8017 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8018 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8019 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8021 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8022 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8025 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8026 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8027 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8028 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8029 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8030 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8031 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8032 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8033 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8035 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8036 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8038 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8040 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8041 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8043 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8044 quote, which it doubles.
8046 .cindex timeout SQLite
8047 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8048 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8049 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8050 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8051 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8052 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8053 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8056 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8057 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8058 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8059 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8062 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8063 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8066 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8067 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8068 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8069 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8072 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8073 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8074 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8084 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8085 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8086 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8087 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8088 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8089 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8090 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8091 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8092 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8094 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8095 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8096 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8097 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8099 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8100 support all the complexity available in
8101 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8105 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8106 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8107 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8109 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8110 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8113 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8114 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8115 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8116 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8117 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8120 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8121 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8122 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8124 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8125 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8126 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8127 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8128 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8130 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8131 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8133 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8134 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8135 senders based on the receiving domain.
8140 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8141 .cindex "list" "negation"
8142 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8143 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8144 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8145 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8146 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8147 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8149 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8150 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8151 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8152 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8153 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8155 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8157 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8158 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8159 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8161 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8163 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8164 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8165 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8167 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8168 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8173 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8174 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8175 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8176 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8177 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8178 filenames are not allowed,
8179 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8180 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8184 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8185 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8187 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8188 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8189 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8191 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8195 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8196 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8197 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8198 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8200 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8201 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8203 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8205 and the file contains the lines
8210 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8211 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8215 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8216 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8217 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8218 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8219 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8220 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8221 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8222 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8224 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8225 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8226 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8227 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8232 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8233 .cindex "named lists"
8234 .cindex "list" "named"
8235 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8236 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8237 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8238 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8239 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8240 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8241 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8243 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8245 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8246 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8247 configured with the line
8249 domains = +local_domains
8251 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8252 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8256 domains = ! +local_domains
8257 transport = remote_smtp
8260 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8261 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8262 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8263 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8265 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8266 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8268 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8270 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8271 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8272 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8274 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8275 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8276 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8278 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8279 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8281 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8282 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8283 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8285 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8287 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8288 referenced lists if you can.
8290 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8291 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8292 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8294 domains = +local_domains
8296 on several of your routers
8297 or in several ACL statements,
8298 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8299 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8300 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8301 the same each time they are referenced.
8303 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8304 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8305 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8306 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8310 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8311 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8312 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8313 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8314 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8317 ALIST = host1 : host2
8318 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8320 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8322 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8324 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8327 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8328 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8330 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8332 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8336 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8337 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8338 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8339 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8340 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8341 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8342 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8343 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8344 message. For example:
8346 domainlist special_domains = \
8347 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8349 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8350 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8351 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8352 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8353 same list each time.
8355 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8356 cache the result anyway. For example:
8358 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8360 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8361 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8365 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8366 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8367 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8368 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8369 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8372 .cindex "primary host name"
8373 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8374 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8375 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8376 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8377 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8378 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8379 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8380 differ only in their names.
8382 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8383 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8384 .cindex "domain literal"
8385 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8386 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8387 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8388 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8389 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8390 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8393 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8394 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8395 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8396 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8397 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8398 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8399 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8400 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8401 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8402 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8403 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8405 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8406 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8407 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8408 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8409 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8411 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8412 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8413 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8414 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8415 on a router). For example:
8417 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8419 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8420 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8422 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8423 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8424 contain negative items.
8426 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8427 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8428 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8430 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8431 an.other.domain : ...
8433 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8434 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8436 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8437 an.other.domain ? ...
8440 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8441 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8442 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8443 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8444 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8445 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8446 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8447 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8448 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8452 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8453 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8454 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8455 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8456 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8457 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8458 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8459 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8460 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8462 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8463 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8464 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8465 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8466 expression by expansion, of course).
8468 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8469 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8470 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8471 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8472 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8473 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8475 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8477 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8478 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8479 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8480 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8481 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8482 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8483 other statements in the same ACL.
8486 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8487 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8489 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8491 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8492 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8495 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8496 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8497 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8498 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8499 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8500 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8503 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8504 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8505 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8506 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8508 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8509 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8511 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8512 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8513 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8514 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8515 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8517 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8518 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8519 between the pattern and the domain.
8522 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8524 domainlist funny_domains = \
8527 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8528 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8529 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8530 nis;domains.byname : \
8531 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8533 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8534 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8535 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8536 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8537 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8542 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8543 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8544 .cindex "list" "host list"
8545 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8546 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8547 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8548 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8549 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8550 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8551 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8554 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8555 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8556 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8557 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8558 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8559 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8562 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8563 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8564 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8568 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8569 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8570 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8571 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8572 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8573 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8574 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8577 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8578 inspecting its IP address:
8581 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8582 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8583 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8584 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8585 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8586 with the IP address of the subject host.
8588 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8589 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8590 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8591 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8592 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8595 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8596 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8597 domain name, as just described.
8600 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8601 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8602 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8603 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8604 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8605 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8606 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8607 that can never match a client host.
8610 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8611 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8612 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8613 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8615 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8619 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8620 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8621 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8622 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8623 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8624 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8625 significant end of the address.
8627 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8628 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8629 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8630 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8634 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8635 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8638 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8640 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8641 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8643 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8644 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8647 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8649 could make use of a file containing
8654 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8655 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8656 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8658 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8661 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8667 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8668 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8669 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8670 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8671 address, the pattern takes this form:
8673 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8677 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8679 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8680 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8681 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8682 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8683 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8684 returned by the lookup is not used.
8686 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8687 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8688 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8689 patterns of this form:
8691 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8695 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8697 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8698 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8699 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8700 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8701 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8703 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8704 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8705 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8706 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8707 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8708 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8709 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8710 converted using colons and not dots.
8712 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8713 addresses are always used.
8714 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8717 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8718 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8719 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8722 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8723 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8724 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8725 case the IP address is used on its own.
8729 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8730 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8731 .cindex "unknown host name"
8732 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8733 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8734 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8735 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8736 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8739 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8740 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8741 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8742 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8743 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8744 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8745 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8747 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8748 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8750 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8751 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8752 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8753 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8754 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8755 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8756 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8757 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8758 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8760 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8761 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8763 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8764 .cindex "alias for host"
8765 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8766 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8769 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8770 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8771 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8772 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8773 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8776 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8777 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8778 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8779 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8780 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8781 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8782 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8787 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8788 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8789 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8790 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8791 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8793 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8795 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8796 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8797 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8804 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8805 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8806 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8807 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8808 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8809 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8811 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8812 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8814 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8815 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8816 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8817 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8818 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8819 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8820 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8821 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8822 not recognized in an indirected file).
8825 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8826 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8828 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8830 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8831 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8834 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8835 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8838 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8841 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8842 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8843 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8846 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8847 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8850 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8852 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8854 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8855 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8856 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8859 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8860 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8861 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8863 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8865 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8866 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8867 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8868 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8869 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8870 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8871 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8874 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8875 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8877 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8878 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8880 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8881 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8882 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8887 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8889 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8890 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8891 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8892 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8893 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8894 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8895 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8896 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8897 host lists such as whitelists.
8901 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8902 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8903 .cindex "unknown host name"
8904 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8905 If a pattern is of the form
8907 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8911 dbm;/host/accept/list
8913 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8914 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8917 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8918 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8919 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8920 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8921 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8922 lookup, both using the same file.
8926 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8927 If a pattern is of the form
8929 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8931 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8932 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8933 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8935 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8936 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8938 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8939 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8940 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8943 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8944 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8945 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8947 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8948 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8949 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8950 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8951 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8952 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8958 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8959 .cindex "list" "address list"
8960 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8961 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8962 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8963 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8964 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8965 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8966 using this option setting:
8970 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8971 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8972 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8973 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8975 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8978 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8980 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8981 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8982 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8983 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8984 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8985 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8986 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8988 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8989 *@+hostile_domains:\
8990 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8991 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8993 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8994 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8995 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8996 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8997 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8999 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9000 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9001 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9002 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9003 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9005 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9008 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9009 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9013 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9014 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9015 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9016 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9017 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9018 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9019 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9021 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9022 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9024 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9025 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9028 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9029 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9030 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9033 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9034 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9035 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9037 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9038 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9039 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9040 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9042 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9043 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9045 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9046 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9047 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9048 default. For example, with this lookup:
9050 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9052 the file could contains lines like this:
9054 user1@domain1.example
9057 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9060 nimrod@jaeger.example
9064 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9065 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9067 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9069 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9070 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9072 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9073 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9074 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9078 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9079 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9084 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9085 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9086 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9087 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9088 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9089 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9090 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9091 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9092 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9094 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9095 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9096 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9097 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9098 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9101 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9103 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9105 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9107 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9109 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9110 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9111 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9112 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9113 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9114 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9116 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9119 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9122 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9123 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9124 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9125 might have entries like
9127 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9128 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9131 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9132 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9133 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9134 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9136 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9137 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9138 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9141 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9142 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9143 can only return a single list of local parts.
9146 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9147 in these two examples:
9150 senders = *@+my_list
9152 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9153 example it is a named domain list.
9158 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9159 .cindex "case of local parts"
9160 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9161 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9162 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9163 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9164 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9165 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9166 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9167 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9170 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9171 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9172 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9173 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9174 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9175 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9176 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9179 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9180 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9181 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9182 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9183 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9184 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9185 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9186 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9190 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9191 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9192 .cindex "local part" "list"
9193 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9194 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9195 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9196 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9197 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9198 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9199 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9200 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9202 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9203 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9204 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9205 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9206 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9207 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9208 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9210 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9218 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9219 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9220 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9221 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9223 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9224 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9225 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9226 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9227 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9228 escape character, as described in the following section.
9230 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9231 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9232 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9233 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9234 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9237 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9238 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9239 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9245 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9246 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9247 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9248 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9249 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9250 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9251 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9252 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9254 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9255 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9256 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9257 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9259 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9261 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9262 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9267 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9268 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9269 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9270 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9271 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9272 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9273 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9276 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9277 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9278 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9281 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9282 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9283 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9285 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9286 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9287 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9288 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9289 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9290 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9291 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9294 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9295 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9296 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9299 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9300 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9301 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9302 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9304 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9306 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9307 Exim message identifier. For example:
9309 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9311 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9312 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9315 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9316 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9317 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9318 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9319 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9320 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9321 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9322 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9323 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9324 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9325 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9326 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9332 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9333 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9334 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9335 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9336 white space is significant.
9339 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9340 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9341 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9346 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9347 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9348 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9349 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9350 given, the expansion fails.
9352 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9353 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9354 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9355 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9359 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9360 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9361 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9362 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9363 string easier to understand.
9365 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9366 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9367 expansion item below.
9370 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9371 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9372 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9373 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9374 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9375 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9376 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9377 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9378 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9379 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9380 the result of the expansion.
9381 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9382 the expansion result is an empty string.
9383 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9386 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9387 .cindex authentication "results header"
9388 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9389 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9390 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9391 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9393 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9394 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9395 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9404 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9406 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9408 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9411 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9412 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9413 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9414 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9415 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9416 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9417 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9418 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9422 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9423 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9428 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9432 If the field is found,
9433 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9434 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9435 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9436 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9438 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9439 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9442 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9444 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9445 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9447 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9448 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9449 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9450 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9451 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9452 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9453 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9454 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9456 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9457 take an optional modifier of "int"
9458 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9459 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9460 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9462 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9463 newline-separated by default,
9464 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9465 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9466 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9468 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9469 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9470 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9471 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9472 if so the element tags are omitted.
9474 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9476 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9477 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9479 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9480 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9484 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9485 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9486 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9488 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9492 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9493 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9494 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9496 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9497 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9498 must have the following type:
9500 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9502 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9503 function should return one of the following values:
9505 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9506 into the expanded string that is being built.
9508 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9509 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9511 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9512 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9514 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9516 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9517 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9518 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9521 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9522 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9523 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9524 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9526 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9527 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9528 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9530 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9531 appear, for example:
9533 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9535 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9536 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9538 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9540 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9543 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9544 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9547 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9548 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9549 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9550 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9551 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9552 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9553 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9554 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9556 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9559 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9560 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9561 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9562 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9563 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9564 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9565 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9566 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9567 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9569 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9570 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9571 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9574 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9575 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9577 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9578 appear, for example:
9580 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9582 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9583 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9585 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9586 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9587 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9588 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9589 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9590 .cindex JSON expansions
9591 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9592 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9593 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9594 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9596 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9599 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9600 the spaces are optional.
9601 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9602 For the &"json"& variant,
9603 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9606 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9607 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9609 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9611 The results of matching are handled as above.
9614 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9615 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9616 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9617 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9618 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9619 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9620 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9621 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9622 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9623 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9624 <&'string3'&> as before.
9626 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9627 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9628 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9629 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9630 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9631 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9632 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9633 provided. For example:
9635 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9639 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9641 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9642 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9645 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9646 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9647 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9648 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9649 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9650 .cindex JSON expansions
9651 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9652 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9654 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9655 there is no choice of field separator.
9656 For the &"json"& variant,
9657 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9660 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9661 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9665 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9666 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9667 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9669 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9670 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9672 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9673 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9674 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9675 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9676 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9678 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9680 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9681 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9684 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9685 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9686 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9687 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9688 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9689 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9691 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9692 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9693 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9694 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9696 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9698 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9699 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9700 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9701 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9702 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9704 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9706 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9707 letters appear. For example:
9709 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9710 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9711 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9714 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9715 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9716 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9717 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9718 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9719 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9720 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9721 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9722 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9723 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9724 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9725 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9726 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9727 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9728 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9729 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9730 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9734 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9735 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9736 lines) may be present.
9738 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9739 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9742 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9743 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9744 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9747 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9748 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9749 are multiple headers with a given name.
9750 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9751 list-processing facilities can be used.
9752 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9753 the content is &"raw"&.
9756 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9757 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9758 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9759 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9760 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9761 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9762 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9763 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9766 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9767 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9768 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9769 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9770 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9771 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9774 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9775 command of the following form:
9777 headers charset "UTF-8"
9779 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9780 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9781 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9782 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9783 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9786 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9787 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9788 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9789 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9791 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9792 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9793 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9794 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9795 router or transport are not accessible.
9797 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9798 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9799 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9800 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9801 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9802 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9803 point they are added.
9804 When any of the above ACLs ar
9805 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9807 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9808 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9809 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9810 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9811 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9812 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9813 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9816 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9817 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9818 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9819 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9820 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9821 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9822 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9823 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9826 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9827 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9829 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9830 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9831 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9832 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9833 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9834 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9835 present. For example:
9837 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9839 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9842 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9844 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9845 an Exim configuration:
9847 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9849 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9852 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9853 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9854 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9856 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9857 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9858 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9859 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9860 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9861 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9864 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9865 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9866 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9867 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9868 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9869 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9871 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9873 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9874 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9875 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9876 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9877 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9879 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9880 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9881 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9883 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9887 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9892 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9893 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9894 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9895 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9896 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9897 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9901 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9902 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9903 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9904 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9905 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9906 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9907 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9910 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9912 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9913 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9914 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9915 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9918 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9919 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9920 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9921 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9922 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9923 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9924 apart from an optional leading minus,
9925 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9927 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9928 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9930 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9931 If the number is negative, the fields are
9932 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9933 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9934 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9936 If the modulus of the
9937 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9938 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9942 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9946 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9948 yields &"result: 42"&.
9950 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9951 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9953 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9956 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9957 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9958 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9959 described in the next item.
9961 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9962 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9963 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9964 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9965 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9966 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9967 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9968 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9969 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9971 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9972 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9973 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9974 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9975 out by the system administrator.
9978 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9979 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9980 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9981 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9982 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9983 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9984 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9985 original lookup fails.
9987 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9988 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9989 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9990 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9991 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9992 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9993 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9994 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9996 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9997 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9998 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9999 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10001 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10002 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10003 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10004 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10006 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10008 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10010 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10011 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10013 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10018 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10019 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10021 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10022 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10024 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10025 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10026 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10027 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10029 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10031 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10032 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10033 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10035 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10036 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10037 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10038 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10039 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10040 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10041 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10043 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10045 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10046 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10047 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10048 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10051 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10053 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10057 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10058 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10059 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10060 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10061 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10062 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10063 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10064 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10066 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10067 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10068 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10069 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10070 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10073 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10074 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10075 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10077 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10078 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10081 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10082 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10083 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10084 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10085 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10086 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10087 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10088 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10090 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10091 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10092 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10093 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10094 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10095 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10096 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10097 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10098 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10099 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10101 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10102 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10103 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10104 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10106 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10107 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10108 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10109 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10110 is the expansion of the third argument.
10112 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10113 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10114 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10116 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10117 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10118 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10119 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10120 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10121 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10122 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10123 newlines are left in the string.
10124 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10125 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10126 the string expansion fails.
10128 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10129 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10133 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10134 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10135 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10136 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10137 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10138 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10139 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10142 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10143 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10145 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10146 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10147 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10148 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10149 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10152 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10154 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10155 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10156 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10157 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10158 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10159 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10160 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10162 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10165 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10166 and must be present if the argument is given.
10167 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10168 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10169 The first defines whether (the default)
10170 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10171 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10173 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10175 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10177 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10179 The default is to not use TLS.
10180 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10182 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10183 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10184 turns them into spaces:
10186 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10188 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10189 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10190 addition, the following errors can occur:
10193 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10195 Failure to connect the socket;
10197 Failure to write the request string;
10199 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10202 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10203 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10204 errors occurs. For example:
10206 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10209 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10210 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10211 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10212 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10213 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10215 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10216 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10219 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10220 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10221 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10222 .vindex "&$value$&"
10224 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10225 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10226 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10227 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10228 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10229 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10230 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10231 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10232 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10233 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10235 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10237 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10240 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10242 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10243 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10246 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10247 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10248 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10250 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10251 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10252 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10253 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10254 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10255 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10256 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10257 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10258 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10260 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10261 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10262 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10263 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10264 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10265 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10266 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10267 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10268 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10271 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10272 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10273 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10274 .vindex "&$value$&"
10275 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10276 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10277 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10278 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10279 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10282 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10283 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10284 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10285 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10287 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10288 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10289 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10292 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10293 log_message = Output of id: $value
10295 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10296 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10298 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10301 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10302 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10303 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10305 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10306 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10310 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10311 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10314 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10315 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10316 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10317 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10319 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10320 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10323 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10324 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10325 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10326 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10327 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10328 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10329 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10330 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10332 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10334 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10335 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10336 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10338 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10340 yields &"defabc"&, and
10342 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10344 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10345 the regular expression from string expansion.
10347 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10348 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10351 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10352 .cindex sorting "a list"
10353 .cindex list sorting
10354 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10355 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10356 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10357 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10358 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10359 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10360 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10361 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10362 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10363 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10364 to give values for comparison.
10366 The item result is a sorted list,
10367 with the original list separator,
10368 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10372 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10374 sorts a list of numbers, and
10376 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10378 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10381 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10382 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10383 .cindex "substring extraction"
10384 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10385 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10386 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10387 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10388 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10390 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10392 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10393 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10396 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10397 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10398 length required. For example
10400 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10402 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10403 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10404 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10405 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10407 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10408 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10409 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10411 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10413 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10414 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10415 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10417 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10419 yields an empty string, but
10421 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10425 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10426 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10427 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10428 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10431 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10433 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10435 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10439 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10440 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10441 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10442 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10443 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10444 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10445 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10446 replacement list. For example
10448 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10450 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10451 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10452 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10455 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10461 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10462 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10463 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10464 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10465 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10466 following operations can be performed:
10469 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10470 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10471 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10472 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10473 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10474 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10476 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10479 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10480 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10481 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10482 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10483 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10484 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10485 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10486 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10487 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10489 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10490 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10491 character. For example:
10493 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10495 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10496 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10497 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10498 separator explicitly:
10500 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10503 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10504 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10505 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10508 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10509 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10510 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10511 email address separator. For the example header line:
10513 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10515 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10516 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10517 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10518 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10519 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10520 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10521 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10523 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10524 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10526 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10527 Last:user@example.com
10528 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10530 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10534 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10535 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10537 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10538 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10539 Only lowercase letters are used.
10541 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10542 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10543 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10544 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10545 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10547 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10548 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10549 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10550 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10551 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10552 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10553 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10554 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10555 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10557 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10558 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10559 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10560 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10561 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10562 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10565 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10567 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10568 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10569 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10570 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10572 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10573 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10576 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10577 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10578 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10579 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10580 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10583 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10584 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10585 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10586 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10587 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10590 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10591 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10592 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10593 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10594 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10595 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10596 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10598 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10599 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10600 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10601 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10602 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10603 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10606 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10607 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10608 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10609 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10610 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10611 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10612 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10613 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10614 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10615 C programming language):
10617 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10618 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10619 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10620 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10621 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10623 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10625 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10626 space is permitted before or after operators.
10628 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10629 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10630 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10631 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10632 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10634 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10636 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10637 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10640 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10641 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10642 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10643 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10644 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10645 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10646 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10647 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10648 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10649 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10650 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10653 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10655 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10658 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10661 {$recipients_count} \
10662 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10666 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10667 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10670 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10671 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10672 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10675 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10677 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10678 and then re-expands what it has found.
10681 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10683 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10684 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10685 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10686 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10687 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10688 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10689 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10690 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10691 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10693 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10694 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10695 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10696 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10697 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10698 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10699 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10702 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10703 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10704 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10705 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10706 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10707 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10709 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10711 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10712 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10716 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10717 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10718 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10719 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10720 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10721 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10725 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10726 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10727 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10728 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10729 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10730 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10731 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10734 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10735 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10736 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10737 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10738 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10739 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10740 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10742 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10743 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10744 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10745 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10746 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10747 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10748 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10749 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10750 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10753 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10754 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10755 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10756 .cindex "lower casing"
10757 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10758 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10759 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10763 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10765 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10766 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10767 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10768 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10769 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10770 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10772 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10774 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10775 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10776 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10777 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10780 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10781 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10782 .cindex "list" "item count"
10783 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10784 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10785 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10788 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10789 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10790 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10791 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10792 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10793 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10794 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10795 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10796 matching list is returned.
10799 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10800 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10801 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10802 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10803 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10805 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10808 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10809 .cindex "masked IP address"
10810 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10811 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10812 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10813 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10814 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10815 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10816 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10817 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10818 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10820 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10822 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10823 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10824 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10825 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10827 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10831 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10833 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10836 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10838 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10839 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10840 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10841 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10842 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10844 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10845 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10848 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10849 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10850 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10851 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10852 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10853 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10855 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10857 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10860 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10861 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10862 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10863 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10864 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10865 is an empty string or
10866 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10867 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10868 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10869 respectively For example,
10877 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10878 variable or a message header.
10880 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10881 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10882 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10883 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10884 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10885 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10886 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10888 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10889 will likely use the quoting form.
10890 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10893 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10894 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10895 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10896 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10897 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10899 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10905 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10906 yields an unchanged string.
10909 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10910 .cindex "random number"
10911 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10912 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10913 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10914 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10915 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10916 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10917 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10918 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10922 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10923 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10924 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10925 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10926 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10927 for DNS. For example,
10929 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10930 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10935 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10939 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10940 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10941 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10942 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10943 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10944 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10945 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10946 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10947 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10950 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10952 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10953 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10957 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10958 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10959 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10960 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10961 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10962 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10963 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10964 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10966 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10967 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10968 to use this operator as well.
10972 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10973 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10974 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10975 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10976 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10977 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10978 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10981 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10982 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10983 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10984 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10985 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10986 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10987 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10989 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10990 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10993 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10994 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10995 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10996 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10997 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10998 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10999 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11000 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11001 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11002 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11004 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11006 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11007 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11010 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11011 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11012 Finally, if an underbar
11013 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11014 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11015 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11019 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11020 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11021 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11022 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11023 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11024 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11026 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11028 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11029 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11030 with 256 being the default.
11032 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11033 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11034 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11035 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11038 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11039 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11040 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11041 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11042 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11043 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11044 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11045 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11046 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11047 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11048 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11049 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11050 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11052 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11053 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11054 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11056 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11057 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11058 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11062 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11063 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11064 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11065 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11066 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11067 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11068 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11071 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11072 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11073 .cindex "substring extraction"
11074 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11075 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11076 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11077 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11079 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11081 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11082 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11083 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11085 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11086 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11087 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11088 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11091 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11092 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11093 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11094 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11095 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11096 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11099 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11100 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11101 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11102 .cindex "upper casing"
11103 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11104 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11105 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11106 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11108 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11109 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11110 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11111 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11112 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11113 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11114 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11115 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11116 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11117 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11118 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11119 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11120 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11121 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11123 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11125 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11126 literal question mark).
11128 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11129 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11130 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11131 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11132 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11133 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11135 .cindex internationalisation
11136 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11137 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11138 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11139 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11140 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11141 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11149 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11150 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11151 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11152 while expanding strings:
11155 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11156 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11157 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11158 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11161 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11162 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11163 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11164 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11170 &`>= `& greater or equal
11172 &`<= `& less or equal
11176 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11178 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11179 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11180 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11181 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11182 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11185 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11186 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11187 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11190 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11191 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11192 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11193 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11194 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11195 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11196 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11197 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11198 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11199 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11200 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11201 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11202 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11203 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11205 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11206 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11207 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11208 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11209 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11210 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11212 An empty string is treated as false.
11213 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11214 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11215 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11217 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11218 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11221 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11225 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11226 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11227 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11228 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11229 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11230 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11231 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11232 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11234 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11236 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11237 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11238 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11239 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11240 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11241 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11242 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11243 included in the binary.
11245 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11246 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11247 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11248 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11249 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11250 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11251 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11252 string in LDAP form is:
11254 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11256 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11257 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11259 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11261 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11266 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11267 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11268 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11269 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11270 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11271 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11275 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11276 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11277 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11278 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11279 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11280 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11283 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11284 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11285 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11286 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11287 whatever its length.
11290 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11291 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11292 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11293 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11295 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11296 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11297 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11298 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11299 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11300 support &[crypt16()]&.
11302 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11303 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11304 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11305 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11306 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11308 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11309 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11310 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11312 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11313 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11314 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11315 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11316 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11318 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11319 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11320 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11321 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11322 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11323 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11325 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11327 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11328 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11330 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11331 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11332 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11333 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11334 exists in the message. For example,
11336 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11338 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11339 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11341 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11342 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11343 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11344 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11345 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11346 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11347 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11348 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11349 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11350 case is defined per the system C locale.
11352 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11353 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11354 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11355 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11356 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11357 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11358 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11359 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11361 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11362 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11363 .cindex "first delivery"
11364 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11365 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11366 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11367 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11370 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11371 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11372 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11373 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11374 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11376 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11377 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11378 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11379 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11380 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11381 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11383 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11384 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11385 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11387 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11388 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11389 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11391 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11392 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11393 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11394 list separator is changed to a comma:
11396 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11398 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11399 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11401 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11404 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11405 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11406 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11407 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11408 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11409 .cindex JSON expansions
11410 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11411 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11412 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11413 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11414 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11416 The array separator is not changeable.
11417 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11418 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11423 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11424 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11425 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11426 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11427 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11428 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11429 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11430 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11431 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11433 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11435 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11436 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11437 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11438 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11439 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11440 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11441 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11442 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11443 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11445 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11447 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11448 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11449 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11450 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11451 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11452 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11454 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11456 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11457 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11459 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11460 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11461 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11462 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11465 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11466 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11467 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11468 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11469 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11470 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11471 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11472 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11473 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11474 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11475 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11477 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11478 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11479 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11480 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11481 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11483 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11484 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11486 This is no longer the case.
11488 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11489 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11491 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11493 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11495 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11496 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11497 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11498 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11499 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11500 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11501 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11502 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11503 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11504 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11505 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11506 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11507 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11511 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11512 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11513 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11514 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11515 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11516 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11517 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11518 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11519 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11521 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11523 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11524 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11525 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11526 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11527 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11528 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11529 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11530 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11531 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11533 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11536 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11537 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11538 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11539 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11540 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11541 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11542 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11543 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11544 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11545 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11546 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11549 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11551 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11552 backslashes is also required.
11554 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11555 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11556 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11557 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11558 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11559 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11560 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11561 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11563 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11564 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11565 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11566 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11567 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11568 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11569 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11570 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11572 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11573 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11574 See &*match_local_part*&.
11576 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11577 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11578 See &*match_local_part*&.
11580 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11581 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11582 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11583 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11584 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11585 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11587 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11589 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11592 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11594 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11596 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11597 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11598 in a single test such as
11599 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11600 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11601 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11602 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11604 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11606 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11608 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11610 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11611 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11612 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11613 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11614 masks. For example:
11616 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11618 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11619 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11620 address mask, for example:
11622 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11624 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11625 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11627 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11631 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11632 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11634 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11636 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11637 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11638 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11639 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11640 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11641 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11642 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11643 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11646 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11648 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11649 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11650 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11651 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11653 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11655 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11656 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11657 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11658 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11661 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11662 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11664 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11665 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11666 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11667 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11669 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11670 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11671 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11672 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11673 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11674 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11675 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11676 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11677 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11678 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11679 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11683 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11684 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11686 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11687 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11688 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11689 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11690 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11691 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11692 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11694 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11695 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11696 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11697 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11698 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11700 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11702 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11704 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11706 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11707 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11708 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11709 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11712 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11713 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11715 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11716 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11717 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11718 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11719 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11720 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11722 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11723 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11724 building Exim. For example:
11726 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11728 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11729 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11730 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11731 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11733 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11734 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11735 configuration, you might have this:
11737 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11739 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11741 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11743 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11744 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11745 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11746 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11747 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11748 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11751 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11753 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11754 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11755 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11756 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11757 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11760 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11761 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11762 this library, you need to set
11764 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11766 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11767 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11769 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11771 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11772 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11773 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11775 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11776 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11777 the authentication is successful. For example:
11779 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11783 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11784 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11785 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11787 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11788 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11789 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11790 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11791 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11792 by a process that is not running as root.
11794 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11795 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11796 building Exim. For example:
11798 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11800 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11801 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11802 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11804 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11805 two are mandatory. For example:
11807 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11809 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11810 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11811 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11816 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11817 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11818 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11819 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11820 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11821 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11822 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11826 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11827 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11828 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11829 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11830 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11833 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11835 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11836 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11837 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11839 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11840 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11841 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11842 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11843 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11844 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11845 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11846 parsed but not evaluated.
11848 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11853 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11854 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11855 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11856 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11857 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11860 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11861 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11862 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11863 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11864 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11865 In the expansion condition case
11866 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11867 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11868 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11869 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11870 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11871 matching condition.
11873 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11874 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11875 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11876 any unused variables being made empty.
11878 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11879 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11880 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11881 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11882 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11883 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11884 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11885 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11886 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11887 during subsequent delivery.
11889 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11890 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11891 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11892 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11893 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11894 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11895 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11896 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11899 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11900 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11901 this variable has the number of arguments.
11903 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11904 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11905 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11906 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11907 be preserved by coding like this:
11909 warn !verify = sender
11910 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11912 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11913 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11916 .vitem &$address_data$&
11917 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11918 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11919 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11920 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11921 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11922 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11925 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11926 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11927 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11928 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11929 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11930 from the child's routing.
11932 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11933 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11934 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11937 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11938 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11939 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11941 .vitem &$address_file$&
11942 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11943 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11944 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11945 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11946 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11948 /home/r2d2/savemail
11950 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11951 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11952 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11953 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11954 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11955 to the relevant file.
11957 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11958 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11959 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11960 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11962 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11963 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11964 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11965 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11967 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11968 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11969 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11970 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11971 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11972 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11973 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11974 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11975 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11977 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11978 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11979 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11980 command line option.
11981 This second case also sets up information used by the
11982 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11984 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11985 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11986 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11987 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11988 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11989 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11990 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11991 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11992 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11996 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11997 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11998 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11999 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12000 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12001 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12002 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12003 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12004 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12005 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12006 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12008 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12009 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12010 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12011 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12012 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12015 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12016 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12017 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12018 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12019 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12020 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12021 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12022 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12023 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12024 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12025 an undefined mechanism.
12027 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12028 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12029 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12030 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12031 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12032 the ACL malware condition.
12034 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12035 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12036 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12037 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12038 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12039 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12041 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12042 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12043 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12044 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12045 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12046 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12047 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12049 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12050 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12051 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12052 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12053 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12055 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12056 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12057 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12058 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12059 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12061 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12062 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12063 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12064 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12065 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12066 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12067 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12069 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12070 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12071 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12072 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12073 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12074 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12075 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12077 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12078 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12079 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12080 address that was connected to.
12082 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12083 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12084 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12085 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12086 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12088 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12089 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12090 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12091 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12092 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12093 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12095 .vitem &$config_file$&
12096 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12097 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12100 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12101 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12102 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12103 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12104 Results of DMARC verification.
12105 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12108 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12109 Results of DKIM verification.
12110 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12112 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12114 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12115 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12116 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12118 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12119 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12120 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12121 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12122 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12123 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12124 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12125 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12126 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12127 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12128 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12129 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12130 &$dkim_key_length$&
12131 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12132 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12134 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12135 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12136 When a message has been received this variable contains
12137 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12138 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12140 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12141 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12142 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12144 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12145 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12146 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12147 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12148 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12149 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12150 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12151 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12152 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12155 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12156 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12157 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12158 case for &$domain$&.
12160 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12161 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12162 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12163 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12165 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12166 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12167 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12168 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12169 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12170 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12172 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12173 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12174 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12176 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12179 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12180 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12181 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12182 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12183 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12184 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12185 the &(smtp)& transport.
12188 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12189 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12190 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12191 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12194 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12195 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12196 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12197 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12198 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12199 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12202 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12203 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12204 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12205 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12209 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12210 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12211 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12212 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12213 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12214 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12215 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12218 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12219 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12220 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12223 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12224 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12225 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12227 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12228 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12229 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12231 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12232 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12233 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12235 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12236 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12237 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12238 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12239 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12240 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12241 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12243 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12244 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12245 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12246 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12247 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12248 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12250 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12251 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12252 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12253 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12254 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12258 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12259 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12260 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12261 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12262 by a setting on the transport itself.
12264 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12265 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12266 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12270 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12271 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12272 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12273 to local and remote transports.
12275 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12276 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12277 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12278 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12279 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12280 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12281 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12284 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12285 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12286 client is connected.
12289 .vitem &$host_address$&
12290 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12291 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12292 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12293 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12295 .vitem &$host_data$&
12296 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12297 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12298 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12299 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12301 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12302 message = $host_data
12304 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12305 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12306 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12307 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12308 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12309 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12310 variables is set to &"1"&.
12313 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12314 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12317 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12318 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12319 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12322 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12323 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12324 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12325 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12326 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12327 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12328 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12329 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12330 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12331 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12333 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12334 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12335 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12338 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12339 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12340 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12342 .vitem &$host_port$&
12343 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12344 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12345 for an outbound connection.
12347 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12348 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12349 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12350 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12351 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12352 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12355 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12356 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12357 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12358 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12359 a unique name for the file.
12361 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12362 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12363 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12365 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12366 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12367 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12371 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12372 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12373 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12377 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12378 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12379 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12382 .vitem &$load_average$&
12383 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12384 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12385 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12386 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12388 .vitem &$local_part$&
12389 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12390 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12391 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12392 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12393 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12395 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12396 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12397 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12398 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12401 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12402 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12403 .cindex affix variables
12404 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12405 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12406 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12407 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12409 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12410 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12411 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12414 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12415 local part of the recipient address.
12417 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12418 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12419 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12421 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12424 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12425 abc\:xyz@test.example
12427 the value of &$local_part$& is
12431 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12432 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12435 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12437 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12438 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12439 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12441 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12442 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12443 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12444 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12445 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12446 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12447 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12449 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12450 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12451 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12452 variable expands to nothing.
12454 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12455 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12456 .cindex affix variables
12457 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12458 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12459 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12461 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12462 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12463 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12464 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12465 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12467 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12468 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12469 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12470 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12472 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12473 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12474 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12476 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12477 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12478 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12479 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12480 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12481 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12482 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12483 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12485 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12486 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12487 This contains the expanded value of the
12488 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12491 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12492 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12493 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12494 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12495 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12496 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12498 .vitem &$log_space$&
12499 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12500 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12501 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12502 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12503 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12504 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12507 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12508 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12509 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12510 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12511 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12512 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12513 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12514 and &"yes"& if it was.
12515 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12516 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12517 as authenticated data.
12519 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12520 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12521 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12522 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12523 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12524 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12525 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12528 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12529 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12530 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12531 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12532 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12534 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12535 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12536 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12537 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12538 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12539 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12541 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12543 .vitem &$message_age$&
12544 .cindex "message" "age of"
12545 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12546 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12547 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12550 .vitem &$message_body$&
12551 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12552 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12553 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12554 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12555 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12556 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12557 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12558 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12559 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12561 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12562 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12563 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12564 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12565 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12567 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12568 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12569 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12570 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12571 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12572 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12575 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12576 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12577 .cindex "message body" "size"
12578 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12579 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12580 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12581 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12582 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12584 If the spool file is wireformat
12585 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12586 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12588 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12589 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12590 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12591 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12592 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12593 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12594 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12595 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12597 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12598 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12599 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12600 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12601 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12602 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12604 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12605 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12606 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12607 contents of header lines is done.
12609 .vitem &$message_id$&
12610 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12612 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12613 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12614 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12615 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12616 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12617 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12618 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12619 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12620 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12621 from the body is not counted.
12623 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12624 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12625 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12626 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12627 header and the body).
12629 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12631 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12633 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12635 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12636 message has not yet been received.
12638 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12640 .vitem &$message_size$&
12641 .cindex "size" "of message"
12642 .cindex "message" "size"
12643 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12644 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12645 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12646 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12647 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12648 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12649 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12650 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12651 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12653 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12654 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12655 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12656 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12658 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12659 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12660 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12661 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12663 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12664 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12665 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12667 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12668 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12669 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12670 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12671 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12672 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12673 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12674 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12675 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12676 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12678 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12679 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12680 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12682 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12683 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12684 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12685 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12686 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12687 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12688 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12689 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12690 the original address.
12692 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12693 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12694 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12695 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12696 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12698 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12699 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12700 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12702 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12703 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12704 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12705 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12706 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12707 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12708 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12709 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12710 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12712 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12713 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12714 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12715 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12716 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12717 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12718 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12719 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12722 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12723 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12724 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12725 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12727 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12728 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12729 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12730 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12733 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12735 This variable contains the current process id.
12737 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12738 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12739 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12740 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12741 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12742 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12743 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12744 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12745 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12746 variable"& error if encountered.
12748 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12749 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12750 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12751 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12752 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12753 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12754 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12757 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12758 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12759 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12760 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12762 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12764 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12766 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12767 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12768 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12769 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12771 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12772 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12773 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12774 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12776 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12777 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12778 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12779 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12781 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12782 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12783 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12784 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12786 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12787 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12788 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12790 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12791 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12792 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12793 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12795 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12796 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12797 .cindex "named queues"
12798 .cindex queues named
12799 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12804 .cindex router variables
12805 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12806 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12807 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12808 and the eventual transport.
12811 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12812 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12813 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12814 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12815 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12817 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12818 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12819 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12820 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12821 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12822 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12824 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12825 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12826 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12827 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12828 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12830 .vitem &$received_count$&
12831 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12832 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12833 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12834 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12837 .vitem &$received_for$&
12838 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12839 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12840 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12841 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12842 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12844 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12845 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12846 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12847 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12848 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12849 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12850 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12853 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12854 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12855 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12856 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12857 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12859 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12861 .vitem &$received_port$&
12862 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12863 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12865 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12866 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12867 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12868 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12869 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12870 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12871 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12872 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12873 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12875 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12876 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12877 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12878 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12879 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12880 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12882 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12883 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12884 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12886 .vitem &$received_time$&
12887 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12888 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12889 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12891 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12892 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12893 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12894 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12895 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12897 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12898 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12900 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12901 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12902 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12903 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12905 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12906 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12907 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12908 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12911 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12912 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12915 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12918 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12919 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12923 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12926 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12929 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12930 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12932 .vitem &$recipients$&
12933 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12934 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12935 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12936 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12937 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12941 In a system filter file.
12943 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12944 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12945 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12946 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12948 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12952 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12953 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12954 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12955 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12956 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12957 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12960 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12961 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12962 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12963 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12965 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12966 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12967 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12968 these variables contain the
12969 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12972 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12973 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12974 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12975 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12976 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12977 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12978 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12980 .vitem &$return_path$&
12981 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12982 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12983 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12984 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12985 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12986 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12987 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12988 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12989 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12990 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12993 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12994 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12995 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12997 .vitem &$router_name$&
12998 .cindex "router" "name"
12999 .cindex "name" "of router"
13000 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13001 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13004 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13005 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13006 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13007 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13008 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13009 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13010 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13013 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13014 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13015 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13016 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13017 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13018 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13019 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13020 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13022 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13023 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13024 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13025 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13026 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13027 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13029 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13030 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13031 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13032 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13033 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13034 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13035 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13036 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13038 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13039 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13040 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13042 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13043 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13044 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13046 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13047 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13048 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13049 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13050 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13053 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13054 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13056 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13057 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13058 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13059 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13061 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13062 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13063 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13064 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13065 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13066 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13067 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13068 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13069 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13070 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13071 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13072 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13073 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13075 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13076 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13077 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13078 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13079 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13081 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13082 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13083 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13084 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13085 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13086 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13088 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13089 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13090 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13091 this variable contains that
13092 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13094 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13095 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13096 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13097 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13098 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13099 &$authenticated_id$&.
13101 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13102 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13103 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13104 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13105 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13106 resolver library states that both
13107 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13108 other times, this variable is false.
13110 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13111 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13112 library, by setting:
13117 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13118 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13120 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13121 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13123 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13124 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13125 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13126 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13129 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13130 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13131 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13132 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13133 other means, this variable is empty.
13135 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13136 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13137 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13138 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13139 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13140 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13141 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13143 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13144 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13145 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13146 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13148 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13149 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13150 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13153 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13154 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13155 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13156 following are true:
13159 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13161 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13162 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13163 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13165 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13166 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13167 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13169 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13170 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13171 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13173 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13174 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13175 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13176 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13178 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13180 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13181 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13185 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13186 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13187 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13188 number that was used on the remote host.
13190 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13191 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13192 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13193 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13194 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13197 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13198 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13199 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13200 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13202 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13203 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13204 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13205 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13206 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13207 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13208 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13209 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13210 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13211 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13212 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13215 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13216 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13217 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13218 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13219 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13221 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13222 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13223 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13224 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13225 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13227 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13228 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13229 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13230 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13231 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13232 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13233 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13235 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13236 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13237 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13238 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13239 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13241 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13242 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13243 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13244 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13245 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13246 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13248 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13249 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13250 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13251 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13252 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13257 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13258 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13259 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13260 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13262 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13263 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13264 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13265 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13266 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13267 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13268 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13270 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13271 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13272 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13273 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13274 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13277 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13278 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13279 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13280 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13281 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13282 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13283 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13284 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13285 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13286 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13287 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13289 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13290 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13291 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13292 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13293 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13294 message is junk mail.
13296 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13297 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13298 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13299 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13301 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13302 &$spf_received$& &&&
13304 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13305 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13306 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13307 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13309 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13310 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13311 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13313 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13314 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13315 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13316 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13317 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13318 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13320 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13321 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13322 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13323 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13324 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13325 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13326 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13327 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13329 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13331 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13334 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13335 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13336 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13337 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13338 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13339 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13341 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13342 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13343 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13344 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13345 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13346 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13347 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13348 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13350 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13351 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13354 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13355 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13356 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13357 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13358 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13359 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13361 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13362 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13363 .cindex certificate variables
13364 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13365 inbound connection when the message was received.
13366 It is only useful as the argument of a
13367 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13368 or a &%def%& condition.
13370 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13371 when a list of more than one
13372 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13374 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13377 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13378 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13379 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13380 inbound connection when the message was received.
13381 It is only useful as the argument of a
13382 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13383 or a &%def%& condition.
13384 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13385 which is not the leaf.
13387 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13388 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13389 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13390 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13391 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13392 or a &%def%& condition.
13394 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13395 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13396 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13397 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13398 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13399 or a &%def%& condition.
13400 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13401 which is not the leaf.
13403 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13404 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13405 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13406 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13408 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13409 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13412 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13413 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13414 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13415 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13416 and &"0"& otherwise.
13418 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13419 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13420 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13421 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13422 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13423 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13424 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13425 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13426 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13428 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13429 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13430 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13433 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13434 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13435 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13438 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13439 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13441 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13442 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13443 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13444 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13447 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13448 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13449 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13452 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13453 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13454 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13456 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13457 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13458 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13459 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13461 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13462 1 No response to request
13463 2 Response not verified
13464 3 Verification failed
13465 4 Verification succeeded
13468 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13469 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13470 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13471 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13472 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13474 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13475 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13476 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13477 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13478 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13479 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13480 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13481 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13482 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13483 which is not the leaf.
13485 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13486 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13489 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13490 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13491 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13492 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13493 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13494 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13495 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13496 which is not the leaf.
13498 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13499 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13500 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13501 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13502 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13503 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13504 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13505 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13506 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13507 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13508 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13510 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13511 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13514 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13515 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13516 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13518 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13521 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13522 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13523 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13526 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13527 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13528 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13529 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13531 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13532 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13533 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13534 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13538 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13539 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13540 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13541 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13543 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13544 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13545 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13547 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13548 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13549 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13551 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13552 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13553 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13554 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13555 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13556 values for those that are behind (west).
13559 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13560 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13561 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13563 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13564 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13565 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13566 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13569 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13570 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13571 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13574 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13575 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13576 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13577 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13579 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13580 .cindex "transport" "name"
13581 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13582 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13583 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13586 .vindex "&$value$&"
13587 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13588 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13589 &*reduce*& expansion.
13591 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13592 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13593 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13594 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13597 .vitem &$version_number$&
13598 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13599 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13600 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13602 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13603 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13604 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13605 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13607 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13608 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13609 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13610 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13619 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13620 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13621 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13622 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13623 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13624 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13629 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13632 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13633 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13634 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13635 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13636 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13637 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13638 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13639 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13640 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13642 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13643 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13644 should usually be something like
13646 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13648 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13649 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13650 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13651 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13652 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13653 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13654 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13655 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13659 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13660 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13661 a startup when Exim is entered.
13663 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13664 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13667 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13668 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13671 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13672 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13673 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13674 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13675 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13676 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13680 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13681 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13682 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13683 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13687 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13688 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13690 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13691 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13692 with an error message of the form
13694 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13696 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13697 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13698 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13699 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13700 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13701 that was passed to &%die%&.
13704 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13705 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13706 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13709 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13711 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13712 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13713 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13715 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13716 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13717 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13718 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13720 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13721 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13722 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13723 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13724 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13725 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13726 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13729 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13730 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13731 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13732 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13733 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13734 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13735 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13736 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13737 avoided, but the output is lost.
13739 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13740 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13741 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13742 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13743 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13744 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13745 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13747 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13749 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13750 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13751 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13752 as the first subroutine argument.
13756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13759 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13760 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13761 "Starting the daemon"
13762 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13763 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13764 .cindex "network interface"
13765 .cindex "interface" "network"
13766 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13767 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13768 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13769 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13770 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13771 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13772 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13773 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13774 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13775 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13776 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13779 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13780 and ports to listen on.
13782 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13783 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13784 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13785 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13786 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13787 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13788 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13789 as an error situation.
13791 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13792 for the outgoing connection.
13796 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13797 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13798 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13799 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13800 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13802 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13803 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13804 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13805 chapter describes how they operate.
13807 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13808 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13812 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13813 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13814 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13818 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13820 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13822 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13823 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13826 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13827 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13828 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13829 colons. For example:
13831 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13834 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13836 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13837 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13840 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13841 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13843 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13844 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13847 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13848 with a colon separator, for example:
13850 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13851 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13855 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13856 default setting contains just one port:
13858 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13860 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13861 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13862 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13863 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13864 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13868 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13869 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13870 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13871 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13872 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13873 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13875 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13877 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13879 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13881 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13885 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13886 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13887 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13888 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13889 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13890 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13893 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13894 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13895 If there are any items that do not
13896 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13897 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13898 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13899 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13903 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13906 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13908 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13909 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13910 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13914 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13915 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13916 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13917 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13918 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13919 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13920 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13921 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13922 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13923 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13924 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13925 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13926 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13929 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13930 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13931 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13933 The common use of this option is expected to be
13935 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13938 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13939 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13941 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13942 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13943 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13944 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13945 connections via the daemon.)
13950 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13951 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13952 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13953 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13954 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13955 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13956 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13957 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13959 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13961 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13962 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13963 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13964 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13965 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13966 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13968 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13970 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13971 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13972 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13973 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13974 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13976 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13977 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13978 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13979 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13980 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13981 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13982 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13983 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13984 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13985 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13986 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13987 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13989 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13990 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13991 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13992 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13993 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13997 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13998 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14000 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14001 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14003 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14004 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14005 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14006 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14008 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14010 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14012 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14014 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14015 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14017 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14018 IPv4 loopback address only:
14020 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14022 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14024 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14026 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14030 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14031 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14032 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14033 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14036 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14037 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14038 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14039 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14041 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14042 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14043 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14044 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14045 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14046 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14047 used for listening. Consider this example:
14049 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14051 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14053 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14055 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14056 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14059 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14060 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14061 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14062 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14063 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14064 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14065 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14066 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14070 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14071 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14072 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14073 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14074 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14075 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14084 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14085 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14086 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14087 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14090 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14091 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14093 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14094 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14095 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14097 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14098 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14099 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14100 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14104 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14105 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14106 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14107 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14108 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14109 listed in more than one group.
14111 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14113 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14114 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14115 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14116 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14117 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14118 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14119 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14120 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14121 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14122 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14123 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14127 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14129 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14130 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14131 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14132 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14133 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14134 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14139 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14141 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14142 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14143 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14144 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14145 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14146 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14147 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14148 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14149 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14150 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14151 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14152 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14157 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14159 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14160 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14161 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14162 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14163 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14164 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14165 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14166 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14167 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14168 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14169 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14170 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14171 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14172 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14173 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14178 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14180 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14181 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14182 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14183 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14188 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14190 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14191 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14192 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14193 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14194 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14195 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14196 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14197 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14198 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14199 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14200 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14201 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14202 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14203 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14204 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14209 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14211 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14212 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14217 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14219 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14220 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14221 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14226 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14228 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14229 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14230 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14231 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14232 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14233 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14234 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14239 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14241 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14242 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14243 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14244 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14245 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14246 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14247 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14248 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14249 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14250 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14251 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14252 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14253 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14254 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14255 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14256 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14258 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14259 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14260 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14261 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14262 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14267 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14269 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14270 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14271 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14272 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14273 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14274 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14275 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14276 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14277 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14278 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14279 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14280 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14281 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14282 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14283 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14284 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14285 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14286 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14287 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14288 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14289 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14290 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14292 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14293 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14294 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14295 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14296 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14297 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14298 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14299 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14300 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14301 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14302 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14303 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14304 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14305 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14306 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14307 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14308 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14309 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14310 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14311 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14316 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14318 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14320 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14322 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14323 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14324 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14329 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14331 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14332 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14333 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14334 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14335 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14336 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14337 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14338 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14339 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14340 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14341 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14342 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14343 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14344 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14345 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14346 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14347 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14352 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14354 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14355 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14356 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14357 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14358 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14359 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14360 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14361 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14366 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14368 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14369 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14370 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14371 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14372 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14373 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14374 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14375 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14381 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14383 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14390 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14391 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14394 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14395 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14396 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14397 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14398 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14399 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14400 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14401 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14402 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14403 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14404 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14405 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14406 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14407 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14408 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14409 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14410 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14412 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14413 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14414 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14415 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14416 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14417 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14418 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14419 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14420 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14421 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14422 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14423 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14424 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14425 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14426 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14427 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14432 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14434 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14435 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14436 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14437 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14438 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14439 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14440 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14441 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14442 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14443 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14444 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14449 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14451 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14452 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14453 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14454 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14456 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14457 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14458 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14459 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14460 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14461 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14462 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14463 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14464 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14465 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14470 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14472 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14473 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14475 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14476 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14477 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14478 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14479 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14484 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14486 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14487 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14488 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14489 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14490 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14491 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14492 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14493 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14494 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14495 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14496 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14497 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14498 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14499 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14500 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14501 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14502 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14503 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14504 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14505 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14506 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14507 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14508 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14509 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14514 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14516 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14517 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14518 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14519 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14520 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14521 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14522 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14523 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14524 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14525 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14526 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14527 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14528 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14529 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14530 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14535 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14536 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14539 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14541 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14542 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14543 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14544 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14545 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14546 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14547 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14549 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14550 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14551 It now defaults to true.
14552 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14554 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14557 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14559 log_selector = +8bitmime
14562 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14563 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14564 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14565 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14566 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14569 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14570 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14571 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14574 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14575 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14576 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14577 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14578 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14580 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14581 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14582 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14583 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14584 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14586 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14587 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14588 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14589 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14591 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14593 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14594 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14595 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14597 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14598 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14599 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14600 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14601 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14602 This option defines the ACL that,
14603 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14604 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14605 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14606 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14608 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14609 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14610 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14611 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14612 of a received message.
14613 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14615 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14616 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14617 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14618 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14620 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14621 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14622 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14623 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14625 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14626 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14627 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14628 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14629 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14632 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14633 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14634 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14635 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14637 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14638 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14639 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14640 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14641 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14643 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14644 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14645 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14646 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14647 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14649 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14650 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14651 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14652 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14653 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14655 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14656 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14657 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14660 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14661 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14662 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14663 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14665 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14666 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14667 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14668 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14670 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14671 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14672 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14673 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14675 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14676 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14677 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14678 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14680 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14681 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14682 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14683 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14684 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14686 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14687 .cindex "admin user"
14688 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14689 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14690 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14691 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14692 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14693 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14694 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14696 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14697 .cindex "domain literal"
14698 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14699 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14700 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14701 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14703 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14704 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14705 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14706 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14707 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14708 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14709 the local host's IP addresses.
14712 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14713 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14714 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14715 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14716 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14717 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14718 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14719 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14720 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14722 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14723 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14724 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14725 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14726 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14727 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14728 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14730 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14731 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14732 letters, digits, and hyphens.
14735 If Exim is built with internationalization support
14736 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14737 this option can be left as default.
14740 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14741 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14742 suitable setting is:
14744 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14745 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14747 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14749 dns_check_names_pattern =
14751 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14754 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14755 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14756 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14757 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14758 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14759 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14760 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14761 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14762 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14763 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14764 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14766 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14767 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14768 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14769 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14770 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14771 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14773 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14774 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14775 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14776 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14778 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14780 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14781 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14782 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14783 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14786 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14787 .cindex "thawing messages"
14788 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14789 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14790 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14791 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14792 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14793 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14795 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14796 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14797 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14800 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14801 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14802 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14804 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14806 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14807 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14810 .option bi_command main string unset
14812 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14813 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14814 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14815 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14818 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14819 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14820 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14821 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14822 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14823 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14826 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14827 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14828 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14829 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14831 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14832 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14833 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14834 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14835 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14836 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14837 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14838 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14839 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14840 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14842 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14843 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14844 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14845 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14846 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14847 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14848 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14849 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14850 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14851 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14853 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14854 during reception of a message.
14855 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14857 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14860 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14861 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14862 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14863 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14866 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14867 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14868 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14869 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14870 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14871 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14872 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14873 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14874 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14876 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14877 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14878 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14879 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14880 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14883 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14884 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14885 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14886 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14887 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14888 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14889 connection. A typical setting might be:
14891 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14893 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14895 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14897 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14900 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14901 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14902 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14903 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14904 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14905 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14908 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14909 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14910 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14911 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14914 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14915 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14916 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14917 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14920 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14921 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14922 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14923 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14926 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14927 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14928 callout verification. The default value is
14930 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14932 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14935 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14936 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14939 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14940 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14942 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14943 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14944 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14945 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14946 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14947 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14948 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14949 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14950 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14951 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14954 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14955 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14958 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14959 .cindex "checking disk space"
14960 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14961 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14962 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14963 message is accepted.
14965 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14966 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14967 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14968 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14969 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14970 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14971 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14972 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14975 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14976 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14978 check_spool_space = 100M
14979 check_spool_inodes = 100
14981 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14982 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14985 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14986 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14987 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14989 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14990 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14991 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14992 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14993 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14994 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14996 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14997 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14998 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15000 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15001 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15002 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15004 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15005 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15006 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15007 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15009 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15010 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15011 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15012 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15014 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15016 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15017 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15018 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15019 administrative user.
15020 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15022 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15023 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15024 .cindex memory debugging
15025 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15026 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15027 it should normally be left as default.
15029 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15030 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15031 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15032 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15033 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15034 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15036 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15037 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15038 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15039 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15040 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15041 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15042 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15044 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15045 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15047 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15048 .cindex "warning of delay"
15049 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15050 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15051 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15052 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15053 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15054 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15055 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15056 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15059 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15061 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15062 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15063 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15064 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15068 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15069 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15071 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15073 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15074 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15075 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15077 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15078 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15079 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15080 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15081 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15082 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15083 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15084 not sent. The default is:
15086 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15087 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15088 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15089 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15092 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15093 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15094 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15095 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15097 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15098 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15099 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15100 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15101 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15102 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15103 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15104 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15106 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15107 .cindex "load average"
15108 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15109 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15110 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15111 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15112 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15115 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15116 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15117 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15118 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15119 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15120 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15121 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15122 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15124 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15125 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15126 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15127 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15128 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15129 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15130 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15131 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15133 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15134 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15135 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15136 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15139 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15140 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15141 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15142 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15143 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15144 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15145 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15149 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512 : sha1"
15150 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15151 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15152 and an order of processing.
15153 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15155 Note that the presence of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15156 Signatures using the rsa-sha1 are however (as of writing) still common.
15157 The default inclusion of sha1 may be dropped in a future release.
15159 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15160 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15161 and an order of processing.
15162 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15164 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15165 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15169 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15170 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15171 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15172 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15173 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15174 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15177 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15178 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15179 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15180 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15181 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15182 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15183 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15184 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15185 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15186 by a setting such as this:
15188 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15190 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15191 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15192 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15193 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15194 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15195 options are applied after this global option.
15197 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15198 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15199 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15200 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15201 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15202 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15203 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15204 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15205 value of this option. The default pattern is
15207 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15208 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15210 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15211 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15212 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15213 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15214 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15217 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15218 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15219 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15221 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15222 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15223 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15224 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15226 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15227 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15228 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15229 not do it internally.
15230 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15231 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15233 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15234 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15235 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15238 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15239 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15240 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15241 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15242 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15243 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15245 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15248 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15249 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15250 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15251 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15252 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15253 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15254 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15255 domain matches this list.
15257 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15258 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15259 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15261 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15262 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15263 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15267 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15268 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15269 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15270 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15271 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15272 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15273 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15274 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15275 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15276 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15277 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15278 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15280 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15283 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15284 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15287 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15288 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15289 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15290 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15291 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15292 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15293 match with this expanded domain list.
15295 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15296 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15297 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15298 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15299 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15300 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15302 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15303 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15304 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15306 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15307 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15308 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15309 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15310 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15312 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15313 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15314 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15315 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15316 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15317 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15318 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15319 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15322 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15324 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15325 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15326 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15329 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15330 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15331 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15332 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15334 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15335 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15336 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15337 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15338 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15339 and accepted from, these hosts.
15340 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15341 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15342 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15343 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15346 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15347 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15348 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15349 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15350 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15351 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15353 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15355 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15356 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15358 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15359 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15360 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15361 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15362 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15363 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15364 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15365 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15366 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15369 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15370 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15371 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15372 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15373 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15374 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15375 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15376 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15377 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15379 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15380 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15381 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15382 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15383 are examined. For example:
15385 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15386 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15387 postmaster@mydomain.example
15389 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15391 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15392 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15393 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15394 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15395 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15398 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15399 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15400 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15402 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15404 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15405 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15406 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15407 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15408 overrides the default.
15410 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15411 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15412 and warning messages. For example:
15414 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15416 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15417 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15418 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15419 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15423 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15425 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15426 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15429 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15430 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15431 .cindex "Exim group"
15432 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15433 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15434 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15435 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15436 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15440 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15441 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15442 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15443 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15444 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15445 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15447 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15448 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15449 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15450 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15453 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15454 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15455 .cindex "Exim user"
15456 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15457 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15458 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15459 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15461 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15462 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15463 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15464 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15467 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15468 .cindex "Exim version"
15469 .cindex customizing "version number"
15470 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15471 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15472 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15475 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15476 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15477 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15478 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15481 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15482 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15484 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15485 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15487 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15488 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15489 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15490 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15491 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15492 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15493 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15494 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15495 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15496 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15500 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15501 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15502 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15503 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15504 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15505 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15506 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15507 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15510 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15511 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15512 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15513 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15517 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15518 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15519 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15520 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15521 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15522 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15523 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15524 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15525 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15526 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15527 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15528 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15529 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15530 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15531 logging that you require.
15534 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15536 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15537 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15538 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15539 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15540 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15541 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15542 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15543 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15545 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15546 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15547 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15550 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15551 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15552 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15553 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15555 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15559 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15560 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15563 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15564 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15565 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15566 implementations of TLS.
15569 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15570 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15571 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15574 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15579 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15580 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15581 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15582 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15583 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15584 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15588 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15589 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15590 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15591 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15592 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15593 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15594 sections are rejected.
15597 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15598 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15599 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15600 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15601 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15602 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15603 zero means &"no limit"&.
15608 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15609 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15610 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15611 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15612 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15613 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15614 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15615 if you want to do semantic checking.
15616 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15620 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15621 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15622 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15623 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15624 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15625 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15626 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15628 helo_allow_chars = _
15630 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15633 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15634 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15635 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15636 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15637 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15638 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15639 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15643 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15644 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15645 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15646 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15647 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15648 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15649 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15650 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15651 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15652 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15653 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15654 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15656 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15657 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15658 EHLO command either:
15661 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15663 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15664 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15665 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15666 calling host address, or
15668 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15671 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15672 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15673 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15675 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15676 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15677 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15679 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15680 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15681 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15682 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15683 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15684 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15685 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15686 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15687 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15690 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15691 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15692 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15693 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15694 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15695 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15696 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15697 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15698 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15700 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15701 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15702 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15703 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15704 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15706 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15707 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15708 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15709 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15712 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15713 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15714 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15715 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15716 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15717 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15718 default configuration file contains
15722 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15723 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15725 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15726 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15727 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15729 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15730 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15731 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15732 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15733 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15734 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15737 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15738 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15739 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15740 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15741 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15744 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15745 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15746 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15747 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15751 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15752 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15753 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15754 as soon as the connection is made.
15755 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15756 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15757 connections immediately.
15759 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15760 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15761 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15762 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15763 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15766 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15767 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15768 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15769 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15770 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15771 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15772 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15773 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15774 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15776 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15778 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15782 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15783 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15784 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15785 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15788 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15789 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15790 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15791 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15792 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15794 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15795 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15797 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15798 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15799 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15800 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15801 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15802 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15803 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15806 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15807 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15808 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15809 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15810 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15814 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15815 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15816 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15817 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15818 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15819 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15821 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15822 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15823 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15824 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15825 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15826 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15827 for frozen messages. For example,
15829 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15831 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15832 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15833 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15834 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15835 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15836 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15839 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15840 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15841 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15842 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15843 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15844 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15845 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15846 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15847 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15848 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15851 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15852 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15854 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15855 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15856 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15857 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15858 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15859 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15860 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15861 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15862 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15864 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15865 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15867 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15868 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15869 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15870 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15872 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15873 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15874 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15877 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15878 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15879 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15883 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15884 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15885 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15886 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15890 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15891 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15892 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15893 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15894 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15895 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15896 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15897 and constrained to be a directory.
15900 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15901 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15902 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15903 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15904 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15905 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15906 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15907 and constrained to be a file.
15910 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15911 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15912 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15913 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15914 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15915 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15918 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15919 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15920 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15921 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15922 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15923 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15924 identity to be proven.
15927 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15928 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15929 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15930 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15931 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15934 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15935 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15936 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15937 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15938 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15942 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15943 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15944 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15945 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15946 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15947 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15951 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15952 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15953 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15954 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15955 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15957 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15958 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15959 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15962 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15963 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15964 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15965 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15966 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15967 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15968 has been built with LDAP support.
15972 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15973 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15974 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15975 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15976 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15977 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15978 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15980 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15981 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15982 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15984 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15985 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15986 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15987 and the default qualify domain.
15989 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15990 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15991 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15992 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15994 .cindex "envelope from"
15995 .cindex "envelope sender"
15996 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15997 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15998 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16000 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16001 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16002 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16007 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16008 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16009 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16010 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16011 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16012 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16013 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16016 local_from_prefix = *-
16018 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16020 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16022 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16023 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16027 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16028 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16031 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16032 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16033 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16034 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16035 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16036 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16037 &%local_interfaces%& is
16039 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16041 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16043 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16046 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16047 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16048 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16049 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16050 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16051 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16052 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16053 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16057 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16058 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16059 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16060 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16061 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16062 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16063 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16064 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16069 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16070 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16071 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16072 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16073 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16074 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16075 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16076 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16077 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16078 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16079 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16080 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16081 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16082 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16083 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16087 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16088 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16089 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16090 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16091 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16092 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16093 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16094 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16096 A path must start with a slash.
16097 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16099 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16100 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16101 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16102 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16103 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16104 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16105 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16108 .option log_selector main string unset
16109 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16110 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16111 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16112 minus characters. For example:
16114 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16116 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16117 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16120 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16121 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16122 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16123 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16124 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16125 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16126 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16127 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16128 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16129 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16130 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16131 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16132 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16135 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16136 .cindex "too many open files"
16137 .cindex "open files, too many"
16138 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16139 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16140 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16141 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16142 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16143 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16144 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16145 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16146 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16147 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16148 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16149 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16152 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16153 .cindex "length of login name"
16154 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16155 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16156 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16157 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16158 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16159 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16162 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16163 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16164 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16165 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16166 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16167 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16168 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16169 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16172 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16173 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16174 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16175 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16176 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16177 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16178 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16181 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16182 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16183 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16184 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16185 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16186 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16187 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16188 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16189 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16190 empty string, the option is ignored.
16193 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16194 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16195 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16196 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16197 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16198 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16199 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16200 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16201 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16202 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16203 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16204 colons will become hyphens.
16207 .option message_logs main boolean true
16208 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16209 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16210 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16211 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16212 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16213 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16214 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16215 which is not affected by this option.
16218 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16219 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16220 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16221 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16222 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16223 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16224 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16225 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16226 optionally followed by K or M.
16228 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16229 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16230 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16231 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16232 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16234 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16235 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16236 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16237 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16238 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16239 message that an individual transport can process.
16241 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16242 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16243 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16244 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16245 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16246 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16247 some problems may result.
16249 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16250 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16251 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16254 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16255 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16256 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16258 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16260 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16261 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16262 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16263 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16264 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16267 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16268 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16269 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16270 contains a full description of this facility.
16274 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16275 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16276 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16277 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16278 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16281 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16282 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16283 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16284 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16285 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16288 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16289 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16290 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16291 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16292 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16294 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16295 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16298 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16300 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16301 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16305 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16306 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16307 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16308 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16309 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16311 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16312 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16313 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16314 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16315 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16316 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16317 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16319 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16320 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16321 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16322 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16323 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16325 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16327 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16328 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16329 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16330 some now infamous attacks.
16334 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16335 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16336 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16338 # Disable older protocol versions:
16339 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16342 Possible options may include:
16346 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16348 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16350 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16354 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16356 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16358 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16360 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16362 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16364 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16368 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16382 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16386 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16388 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16390 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16392 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16396 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16399 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16400 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16401 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16402 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16403 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16404 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16407 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16408 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16409 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16410 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16411 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16414 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16415 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16416 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16417 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16418 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16419 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16420 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16421 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16422 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16423 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16426 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16427 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16428 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16429 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16430 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16431 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16432 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16435 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16437 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16438 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16441 .option perl_startup main string unset
16443 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16444 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16446 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16448 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16451 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16452 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16453 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16454 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16455 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16456 PostgreSQL support.
16459 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16460 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16461 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16462 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16463 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16466 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16468 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16470 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16471 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16472 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16475 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16476 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16477 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16478 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16479 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16480 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16481 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16482 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16483 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16486 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16487 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16488 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16489 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16490 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16491 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16492 commands are acceptable.
16493 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16495 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16497 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16501 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16502 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16503 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16504 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16505 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16506 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16507 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16508 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16510 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16511 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16512 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16513 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16514 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16515 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16516 volume of mail. Use with care!
16519 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16520 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16521 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16522 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16523 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16524 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16525 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16526 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16527 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16528 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16530 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16531 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16532 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16533 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16534 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16535 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16538 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16539 .cindex "printing characters"
16540 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16541 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16542 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16543 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16544 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16545 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16548 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16549 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16550 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16551 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16552 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16556 .option process_log_path main string unset
16557 .cindex "process log path"
16558 .cindex "log" "process log"
16559 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16560 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16561 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16562 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16563 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16564 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16565 different spool directories.
16568 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16569 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16573 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16574 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16575 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16578 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16579 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16580 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16581 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16582 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16583 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16584 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16585 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16586 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16588 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16589 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16590 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16591 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16592 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16593 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16594 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16597 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16598 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16599 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16603 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16604 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16605 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16606 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16607 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16608 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16609 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16610 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16613 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16614 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16616 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16617 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16618 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16619 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16622 .option queue_only main boolean false
16623 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16624 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16625 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16626 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16627 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16628 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16630 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16631 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16632 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16633 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16636 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16637 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16638 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16639 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16640 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16641 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16642 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16643 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16644 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16646 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16648 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16649 &_/some/file_& exists.
16652 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16653 .cindex "load average"
16654 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16655 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16656 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16657 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16658 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16659 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16660 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16663 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16664 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16665 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16666 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16669 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16670 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16671 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16672 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16673 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16674 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16675 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16676 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16677 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16678 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16679 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16680 re-evaluated for each message.
16683 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16684 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16685 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16686 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16687 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16688 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16691 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16692 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16693 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16694 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16695 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16696 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16697 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16698 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16699 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16700 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16701 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16702 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16703 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16707 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16708 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16709 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16710 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16711 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16712 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16713 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16714 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16715 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16717 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16718 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16719 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16720 the daemon's command line.
16722 .cindex queues named
16723 .cindex "named queues"
16724 To set limits for different named queues use
16725 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16727 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16728 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16729 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16730 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16731 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16732 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16733 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16734 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16735 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16736 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16737 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16738 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16739 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16743 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16744 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16745 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16746 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16747 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16748 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16749 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16751 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16752 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16753 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16754 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16755 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16756 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16757 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16758 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16759 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16762 The default setting is:
16765 received_header_text = Received: \
16766 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16767 {${if def:sender_ident \
16768 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16769 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16770 by $primary_hostname \
16771 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16772 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16773 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16774 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16775 ${if def:sender_address \
16776 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16777 id $message_exim_id\
16778 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16782 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16783 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16784 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16785 header lines such as the following:
16787 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16788 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16789 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16790 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16791 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16792 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16793 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16795 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16796 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16797 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16798 message was accepted.
16801 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16802 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16803 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16804 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16805 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16806 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16807 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16808 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16811 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16812 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16813 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16814 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16815 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16816 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16817 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16818 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16819 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16820 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16821 option was not set.
16824 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16825 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16826 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16827 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16828 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16829 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16830 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16831 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16834 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16835 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16836 RCPT commands in a single message.
16839 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16840 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16841 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16842 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16843 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16844 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16845 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16848 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16849 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16850 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16851 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16852 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16853 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16854 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16855 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16856 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16857 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16858 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16859 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16860 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16861 tagged with its process id.
16863 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16864 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16865 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16866 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16869 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16870 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16871 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16872 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16873 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16874 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16875 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16876 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16877 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16878 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16879 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16881 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16882 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16883 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16884 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16887 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16888 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16889 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16890 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16891 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16893 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16895 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16896 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16899 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16900 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16901 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16902 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16903 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16907 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16908 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16909 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16910 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16911 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16912 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16913 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16917 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16918 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16919 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16920 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16921 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16922 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16923 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16924 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16925 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16926 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16929 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16930 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16933 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16935 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16936 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16937 an item in the list.
16938 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16941 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16942 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16943 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16944 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16945 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16948 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16949 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16950 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16951 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16952 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16953 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16954 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16955 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16956 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16957 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16959 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
16960 .cindex "environment"
16961 This option allows to add individual environment variables that the
16962 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16963 default list is empty.
16966 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16967 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16968 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16969 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16970 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16971 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16972 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16976 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16977 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16978 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16979 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16980 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16981 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16982 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16983 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16984 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16985 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16986 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16990 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16991 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16992 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16994 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16995 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16996 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16997 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16998 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16999 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17001 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17002 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17003 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17004 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17007 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17008 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17009 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17010 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17011 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17012 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17013 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17014 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17016 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17017 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17018 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17019 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17020 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17021 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17022 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17023 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17026 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17027 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17028 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17029 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17033 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17034 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17035 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17036 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17037 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17038 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17039 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17040 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17041 . the option name to split.
17043 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17044 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17045 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17046 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17047 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17048 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17049 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17050 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17051 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17055 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17056 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17057 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17058 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17059 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17060 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17061 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17062 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17063 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17064 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17065 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17067 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17068 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17069 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17070 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17071 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17072 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17076 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17077 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17078 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17079 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17080 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17081 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17082 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17083 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17084 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17085 to all messages received in the same connection.
17087 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17088 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17089 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17090 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17093 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17095 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17096 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17097 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17098 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17099 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17100 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17101 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17102 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17103 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17104 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17105 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17106 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17107 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17110 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17111 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17112 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17113 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17114 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17115 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17116 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17117 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17118 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17119 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17120 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17123 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17124 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17125 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17126 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17129 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17130 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17131 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17132 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17133 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17134 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17135 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17136 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17137 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17139 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17140 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17141 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17142 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17144 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17145 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17146 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17147 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17148 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17151 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17152 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17155 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17156 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17157 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17158 &%helo_data%& value.
17160 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17161 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17162 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17163 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17164 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17165 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17166 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17168 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17169 $version_number $tod_full
17171 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17172 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17173 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17174 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17175 multiline response).
17178 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17179 .cindex "checking disk space"
17180 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17181 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17182 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17183 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17184 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17185 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17186 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17189 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17190 .cindex "connection backlog"
17191 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17192 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17193 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17194 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17195 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17196 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17197 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17198 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17199 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17200 attacks by SYN flooding.
17203 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17204 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17205 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17206 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17207 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17208 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17209 fewer, but they still exist.
17211 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17212 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17213 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17214 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17215 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17216 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17217 does detect many instances.
17219 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17220 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17221 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17222 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17226 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17227 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17228 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17229 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17230 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17231 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17232 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17233 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17236 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17237 $sender_host_address
17239 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17240 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17241 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17242 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17243 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17247 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17248 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17249 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17250 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17251 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17254 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17255 .cindex "load average"
17256 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17257 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17258 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17259 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17260 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17261 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17265 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17266 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17267 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17268 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17269 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17271 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17273 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17274 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17275 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17276 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17277 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17279 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17280 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17281 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17282 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17283 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17284 not count towards the limit.
17288 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17289 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17290 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17291 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17292 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17295 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17296 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17300 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17301 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17302 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17303 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17304 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17305 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17308 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17309 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17310 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17311 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17313 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17314 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17315 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17316 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17320 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17322 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17323 fractional parts are allowed here.
17325 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17327 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17328 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17331 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17332 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17334 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17335 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17337 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17338 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17339 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17340 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17343 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17344 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17347 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17348 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17351 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17352 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17353 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17354 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17355 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17356 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17357 the message is abandoned.
17358 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17360 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17361 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17363 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17364 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17366 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17367 expanded before use and may depend on
17368 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17372 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17373 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17374 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17375 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17376 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17379 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17380 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17381 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17384 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17385 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17386 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17387 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17388 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17389 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17390 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17391 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17392 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17393 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17395 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17396 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17400 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17401 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17402 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17403 the availability thereof is advertised in
17404 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17405 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17408 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17409 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17410 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17411 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17415 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17416 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17417 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17421 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17422 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17423 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17424 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17425 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17426 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17427 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17428 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17429 arrival of the message.
17431 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17432 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17433 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17434 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17435 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17437 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17438 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17439 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17440 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17441 automatically deleted.
17443 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17444 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17445 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17446 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17447 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17448 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17449 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17450 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17451 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17454 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17455 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17456 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17457 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17458 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17459 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17460 &$primary_hostname$&.
17462 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17463 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17464 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17465 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17466 as failures in the configuration file.
17468 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17469 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17471 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17472 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17473 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17474 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17475 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17476 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17479 The following variables will not have useful values:
17481 $max_received_linelength
17486 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17487 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17488 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17489 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17491 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17492 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17493 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17495 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17496 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17497 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17498 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17500 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17501 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17502 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17503 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17504 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17505 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17507 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17508 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17509 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17510 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17511 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17512 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17513 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17516 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17517 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17518 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17519 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17520 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17521 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17522 domain causes a syntax error.
17523 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17527 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17528 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17529 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17530 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17531 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17532 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17533 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17534 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17535 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17536 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17537 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17538 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17541 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17542 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17543 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17544 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17545 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17546 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17547 details of Exim's logging.
17550 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17551 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17552 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17553 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17554 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17555 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17556 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17560 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17561 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17562 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17563 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17564 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17568 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17569 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17570 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17571 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17572 details of Exim's logging.
17575 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17576 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17577 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17578 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17579 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17580 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17581 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17582 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17583 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17584 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17585 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17586 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17589 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17590 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17591 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17592 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17593 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17594 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17597 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17598 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17599 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17600 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17601 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17603 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17604 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17605 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17606 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17607 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17609 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17610 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17611 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17612 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17613 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17614 contains the pipe command.
17617 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17618 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17619 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17620 is used in a system filter.
17623 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17624 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17625 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17626 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17627 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17628 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17629 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17630 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17631 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17632 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17634 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17635 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17636 transport option overrides.
17639 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17640 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17641 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17642 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17643 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17644 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17645 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17646 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17647 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17648 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17649 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17650 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17654 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17655 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17656 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17657 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17658 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17659 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17660 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17661 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17662 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17663 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17665 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17666 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17667 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17670 .option timezone main string unset
17671 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17672 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17673 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17674 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17675 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17676 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17680 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17681 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17682 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17683 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17684 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17685 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17688 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17689 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17690 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17691 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17692 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17693 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17694 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17695 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17696 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17697 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17698 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17701 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17702 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17703 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17704 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17705 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17706 Commonly only one file is needed.
17707 The server's private key is also
17708 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17709 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17711 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17712 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17713 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17714 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17716 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17717 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17719 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17720 when a list of more than one
17721 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17723 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17726 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17727 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17728 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17729 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17731 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17732 generated for every connection.
17734 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17735 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17736 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17737 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17738 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17740 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17742 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17743 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17744 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17746 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17749 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17750 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17751 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17752 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17753 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17754 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17756 The value must be at least 1024.
17758 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17759 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17760 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17762 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17765 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17766 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17767 larger prime than requested.
17770 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17771 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17772 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17773 to be used by Exim.
17776 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17777 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17780 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17781 for other TLS library versions,
17782 using a filename with site-generated
17783 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17784 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17785 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17787 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17788 then it names a file from which DH
17789 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17790 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17791 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17792 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17793 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17794 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17796 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17799 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17800 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17801 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17802 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17804 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17805 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17807 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17808 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17809 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17811 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17812 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17813 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17814 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17815 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17817 The available standard primes are:
17818 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17819 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17820 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17821 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17823 The available additional primes are:
17824 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17826 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17827 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17828 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17829 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17830 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17832 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17833 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17834 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17836 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17837 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17838 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17839 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17840 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17843 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17844 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17845 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17846 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17847 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17848 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17849 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17852 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17853 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17854 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17855 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17857 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17858 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17859 for valid selections.
17861 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17862 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17863 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17865 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17868 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17869 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17870 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17872 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17873 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17874 Certificate Authority.
17876 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17878 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17882 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17884 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17885 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17886 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17888 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17892 The file(s) should be in DER format,
17893 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17895 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17896 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17897 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17898 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17899 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17900 (this only works under TLS1.3)
17901 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17903 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17904 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17905 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17906 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17909 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17912 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17913 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17914 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17915 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17919 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17920 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17921 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17922 files which contains the server's private keys.
17923 If this option is unset, or if
17924 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17925 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17926 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17928 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17931 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17932 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17933 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17934 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17935 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17936 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17940 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17941 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17942 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17943 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17944 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17945 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17946 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17947 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17948 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17949 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17950 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17953 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17954 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17955 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17956 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17959 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17960 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17961 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17962 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17964 or the absolute path to
17965 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17966 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17968 The "system" value for the option will use a
17969 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17970 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17971 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17974 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17975 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17977 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17979 either by file or directory
17980 are added to those given by the system default location.
17982 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17983 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17984 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17985 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17986 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17987 use the explicit directory version.
17989 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17991 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17995 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17996 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17997 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17998 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17999 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18000 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18001 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18002 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18004 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18005 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18006 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18007 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18008 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18009 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18010 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18012 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18013 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18014 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18015 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18016 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18017 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18018 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18021 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18025 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18026 .cindex "trusted groups"
18027 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18028 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18029 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18030 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18031 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18032 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18033 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18036 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18037 .cindex "trusted users"
18038 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18039 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18040 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18041 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18042 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18043 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18044 Exim user are trusted.
18046 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18047 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18048 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18049 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18050 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18051 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18052 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18053 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18054 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18057 .option unknown_username main string unset
18058 See &%unknown_login%&.
18060 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18061 .cindex "trusted users"
18062 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18063 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18064 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18065 .cindex "envelope from"
18066 .cindex "envelope sender"
18067 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18068 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18069 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18070 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18071 is used) is ignored.
18073 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18074 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18076 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18078 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18079 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18080 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18081 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18082 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18083 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18084 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18085 followed by a hyphen
18086 by a setting like this:
18088 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18090 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18091 restriction, you can use
18093 untrusted_set_sender = *
18095 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18096 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18097 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18098 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18099 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18100 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18101 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18102 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18104 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18105 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18106 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18107 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18111 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18112 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18113 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18114 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18115 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18116 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18117 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18118 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18119 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18120 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18122 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18123 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18125 The pattern can be seen by running
18127 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18129 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18130 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18131 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18132 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18133 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18134 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18137 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18138 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18141 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18142 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18143 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18144 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18145 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18146 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18147 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18148 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18151 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18152 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18153 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18154 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18155 .ecindex IIDconfima
18156 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18164 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18165 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18166 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18167 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18168 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18170 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18171 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18172 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18173 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18174 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18178 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18179 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18180 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18181 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18182 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18183 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18184 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18186 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18187 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18188 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18189 routers, and the eventual transport.
18191 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18192 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18193 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18194 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18195 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18197 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18198 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18199 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18200 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18201 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18203 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18204 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18205 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18207 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18209 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18211 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18213 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18214 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18217 See also the &%set%& option below.
18220 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18221 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18222 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18223 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18224 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18225 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18226 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18230 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18232 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18233 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18234 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18235 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18236 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18241 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18242 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18243 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18244 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18245 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18246 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18247 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18248 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18249 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18250 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18253 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18255 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18258 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18260 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18261 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18262 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18263 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18266 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18267 .cindex "case of local parts"
18268 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18269 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18270 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18271 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18272 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18273 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18274 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18277 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18278 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18279 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18280 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18281 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18282 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18283 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18284 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18285 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18287 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18288 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18289 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18290 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18294 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18295 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18296 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18297 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18299 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18300 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18301 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18302 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18303 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18304 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18305 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18306 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18307 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18308 the router is skipped.
18310 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18311 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18312 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18313 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18314 setting to achieve this. For example:
18316 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18318 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18319 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18320 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18324 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18325 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18326 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18327 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18328 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18329 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18330 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18331 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18333 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18334 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18336 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18337 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18339 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18340 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18341 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18343 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18345 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18347 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18350 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18352 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18353 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18357 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18358 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18359 be specified using &%condition%&.
18361 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18362 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18363 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18364 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18365 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18366 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18367 Router rules processing behavior.
18369 This is best illustrated in an example:
18371 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18372 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18374 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18377 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18380 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18381 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18382 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18383 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18384 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18385 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18386 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18387 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18389 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18390 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18391 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18392 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18395 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18396 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18397 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18398 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18399 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18402 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18403 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18404 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18405 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18406 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18407 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18408 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18409 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18410 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18411 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18412 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18413 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18414 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18415 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18419 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18420 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18421 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18422 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18423 transport option of the same name.
18425 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18426 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18427 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18428 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18429 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18430 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18431 the dnssec request bit set.
18432 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18434 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18435 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18436 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18437 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18438 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18439 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18440 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18441 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18442 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18445 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18446 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18447 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18448 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18449 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18450 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18451 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18452 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18456 .option driver routers string unset
18457 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18461 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18462 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18463 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18464 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18465 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18466 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18467 Not effective on redirect routers.
18471 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18472 .cindex "envelope from"
18473 .cindex "envelope sender"
18474 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18475 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18476 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18477 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18478 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18479 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18480 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18482 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18483 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18484 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18487 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18488 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18489 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18490 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18492 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18493 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18494 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18495 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18501 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18502 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18503 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18504 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18505 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18507 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18508 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18509 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18510 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18511 setting &%return_path%&.
18513 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18514 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18515 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18519 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18520 .cindex "address" "testing"
18521 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18522 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18523 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18524 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18525 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18526 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18527 on for the system alias file.
18528 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18531 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18532 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18533 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18537 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18538 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18539 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18540 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18544 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18545 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18546 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18550 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18551 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18552 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18556 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18557 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18558 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18559 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18560 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18561 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18562 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18563 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18564 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18566 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18567 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18568 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18569 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18570 transport for further details.
18573 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18574 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18575 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18576 .cindex "transport" "local"
18577 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18578 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18579 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18581 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18582 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18583 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18584 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18585 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18589 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18590 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18591 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18592 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18593 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18594 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18595 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18596 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18597 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18598 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18599 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18600 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18601 &"see"& the added header lines.
18603 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18604 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18605 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18606 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18608 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18609 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18611 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18612 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18614 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18615 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18616 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18617 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18618 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18619 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18620 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18621 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18622 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18623 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18627 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18628 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18629 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18630 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18631 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18632 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18633 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18634 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18635 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18636 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18637 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18638 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18639 &"see"& the original header lines.
18641 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18642 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18643 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18646 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18647 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18649 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18650 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18652 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18653 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18654 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18655 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18657 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18658 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18659 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18663 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18664 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18665 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18666 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18667 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18668 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18669 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18672 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18676 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18678 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18679 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18680 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18681 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18682 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18683 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18685 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18686 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18688 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18689 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18691 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18692 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18694 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18695 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18696 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18697 domain that is being routed.
18699 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18700 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18703 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18704 .cindex "additional groups"
18705 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18706 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18707 .cindex "transport" "local"
18708 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18709 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18710 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18711 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18712 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18716 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18717 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18718 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18719 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18720 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18721 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18722 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18725 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18726 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18727 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18728 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18729 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18730 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18731 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18732 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18733 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18735 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18736 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18737 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18738 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18739 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18740 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18741 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18742 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18743 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18744 the relevant transport.
18746 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18747 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18748 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18751 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18752 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18753 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18754 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18755 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18759 local_part_prefix = real-
18761 transport = local_delivery
18763 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18764 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18766 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18767 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18770 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18771 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18772 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18773 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18776 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18777 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18781 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18782 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18783 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18784 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18785 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18786 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18787 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18788 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18789 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18793 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18794 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18798 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18799 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18800 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18801 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18802 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18804 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18805 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18808 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18810 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18811 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18812 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18813 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18814 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18815 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18816 each virtual domain:
18820 local_parts = postmaster
18821 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18825 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18826 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18827 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18828 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18829 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18830 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18831 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18832 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18833 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18834 redirect addresses.
18838 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18839 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18840 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18841 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18842 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18843 delivery to be deferred.
18845 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18846 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18848 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18849 means of the setting
18853 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18854 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18855 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18857 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18858 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18859 controls what happens next.
18862 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18863 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18864 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18865 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18866 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18867 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18868 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18869 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18871 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18872 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18873 applies to all of them.
18877 .option pass_router routers string unset
18878 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18879 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18880 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18881 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18882 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18883 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18884 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18885 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18886 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18887 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18891 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18892 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18893 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18894 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18895 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18896 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18898 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18899 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18900 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18901 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18905 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18906 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18907 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18908 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18909 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18910 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18911 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18913 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18914 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18915 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18916 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18917 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18919 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18920 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18921 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18922 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18923 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18926 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18927 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18930 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18931 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18932 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18933 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18934 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18935 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18936 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18937 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18939 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18940 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18941 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18942 operates as follows:
18944 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18945 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18946 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18947 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18950 require_files = mail:/some/file
18951 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18953 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18954 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18956 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18957 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18958 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18959 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18961 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18962 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18963 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18964 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18965 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18967 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18968 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18969 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18970 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18971 check again in that process.
18973 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18974 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18975 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18976 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18977 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18978 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18979 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18981 require_files = +/some/file
18983 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18984 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18985 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18989 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18990 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18991 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18992 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18993 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18994 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18995 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18996 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18999 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19000 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19002 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19003 &%check_local_user%&,
19006 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19007 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19011 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19012 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19015 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19016 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19017 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19019 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19020 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19021 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19025 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19026 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19027 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19029 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19030 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19031 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19032 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19033 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19034 cause the router to defer.
19036 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19037 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19039 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19041 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19042 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19044 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19045 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19046 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19047 of these values that is set:
19050 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19052 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19054 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19056 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19059 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19060 router, but not for the transport.
19064 .option self routers string freeze
19065 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19066 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19067 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19068 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19069 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19070 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19072 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19073 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19074 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19075 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19076 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19078 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19079 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19080 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19081 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19082 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19087 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19089 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19090 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19091 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19092 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19094 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19095 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19096 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19101 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19102 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19103 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19104 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19105 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19106 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19112 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19113 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19114 be passed to the next router.
19117 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19120 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19121 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19122 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19123 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19124 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19125 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19130 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19131 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19132 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19133 address matches something on the list.
19134 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19137 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19138 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19139 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19140 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19141 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19142 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19143 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19148 .option set routers "string list" unset
19149 .cindex router variables
19150 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19151 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19152 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19155 Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19156 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19157 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19158 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19159 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19161 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19162 The variables can be used by the router options
19163 (not including any preconditions)
19164 and by the transport.
19165 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19166 Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19168 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19169 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19173 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19174 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19175 .cindex "packet radio"
19176 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19177 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19178 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19179 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19180 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19181 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19182 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19183 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19185 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19186 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19187 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19188 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19189 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19190 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19191 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19192 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19193 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19194 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19196 translate_ip_address = \
19197 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19200 The file would contain lines like
19202 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19203 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19205 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19210 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19211 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19212 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19213 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19214 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19215 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19216 delivery is deferred.
19218 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19219 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19220 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19224 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19225 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19226 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19227 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19228 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19229 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19230 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19231 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19232 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19233 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19234 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19240 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19241 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19242 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19243 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19244 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19245 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19246 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19247 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19248 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19249 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19251 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19252 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19253 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19254 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19255 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19257 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19263 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19264 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19265 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19266 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19267 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19268 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19269 delivery to be deferred.
19271 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19272 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19273 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19274 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19275 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19276 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19278 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19279 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19280 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19281 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19282 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19283 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19284 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19285 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19287 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19288 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19289 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19290 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19291 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19292 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19293 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19294 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19295 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19296 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19298 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19299 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19300 subsequent routers.
19303 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19304 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19305 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19306 .cindex "transport" "local"
19307 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19308 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19309 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19310 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19311 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19312 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19313 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19314 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19315 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19316 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19317 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19318 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19322 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19323 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19324 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19327 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19328 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19330 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19331 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19332 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19333 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19334 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19335 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19336 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19338 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19339 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19340 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19344 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19345 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19347 delivering in cutthrough mode
19348 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19349 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19351 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19354 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19355 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19356 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19357 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19359 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19360 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19361 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19368 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19371 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19372 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19373 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19374 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19375 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19376 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19377 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19378 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19379 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19383 domains = mydomain.example
19385 transport = local_delivery
19387 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19388 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19389 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19390 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19400 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19401 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19402 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19403 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19404 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19405 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19407 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19408 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19409 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19410 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19413 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19414 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19415 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19416 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19417 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19418 generic option, the router declines.
19420 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19421 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19422 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19424 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19425 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19426 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19427 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19428 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19429 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19432 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19433 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19434 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19435 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19436 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19437 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19439 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19440 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19441 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19442 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19443 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19444 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19445 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19446 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19447 case routing fails.
19450 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19451 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19452 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19453 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19454 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19456 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19457 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19459 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19461 The domain does not exist in DNS
19463 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19464 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19465 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19467 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19469 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19471 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19472 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19474 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19475 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19477 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19478 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19480 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19481 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19487 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19488 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19489 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19491 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19492 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19493 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19494 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19495 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19496 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19497 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19500 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19501 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19502 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19503 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19504 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19505 required. For example,
19509 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19510 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19511 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19512 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19513 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19516 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19517 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19518 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19519 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19520 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19521 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19523 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19524 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19525 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19526 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19527 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19528 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19529 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19530 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19532 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19533 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19538 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19539 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19540 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19541 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19542 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19543 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19544 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19545 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19549 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19550 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19551 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19552 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19553 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19554 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19555 only A records are used.
19557 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19558 .cindex IPv4 preference
19559 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19560 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19561 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19562 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19563 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19565 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19566 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19567 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19568 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19569 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19570 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19571 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19574 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19576 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19577 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19578 the address record.
19581 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19582 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19583 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19584 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19589 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19590 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19591 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19592 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19593 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19594 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19595 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19596 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19597 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19602 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19603 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19604 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19605 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19606 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19607 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19608 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19609 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19610 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19611 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19612 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19614 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19615 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19618 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19619 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19620 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19621 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19622 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19626 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19627 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19628 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19629 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19630 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19631 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19632 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19633 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19635 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19636 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19637 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19638 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19639 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19640 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19641 without processing them independently,
19642 provided the following conditions are met:
19645 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19646 &%headers_remove%&.
19648 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19655 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19656 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19657 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19658 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19659 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19660 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19661 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19662 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19663 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19664 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19666 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19667 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19672 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19673 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19674 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19675 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19680 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19681 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19682 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19683 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19686 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19688 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19689 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19690 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19691 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19692 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19693 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19696 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19697 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19698 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19699 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19700 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19702 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19703 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19704 such as that implied by
19708 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19709 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19710 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19711 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19724 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19725 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19726 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19727 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19728 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19729 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19730 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19731 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19732 router handles the address
19736 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19737 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19738 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19740 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19742 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19743 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19745 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19746 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19747 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19748 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19750 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19751 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19752 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19753 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19760 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19761 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19762 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19763 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19764 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19765 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19768 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19770 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19772 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19773 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19774 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19775 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19776 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19777 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19778 must not be specified for it.
19780 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19781 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19782 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19783 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19784 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19785 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19786 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19789 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19790 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19791 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19792 delivery to the address is deferred.
19795 .option port iplookup integer 0
19796 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19797 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19801 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19802 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19803 protocols is to be used.
19806 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19807 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19810 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19812 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19813 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19816 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19817 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19818 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19819 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19820 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19821 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19822 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19823 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19826 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19827 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19828 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19829 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19830 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19831 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19832 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19833 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19834 following could be used:
19836 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19837 reroute = $local_part@$1
19840 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19841 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19842 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19843 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19851 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19852 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19853 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19854 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19855 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19856 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19857 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19858 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19859 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19860 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19862 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19863 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19864 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19865 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19866 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19867 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19868 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19871 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19872 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19873 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19874 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19875 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19876 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19877 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19880 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19881 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19882 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19883 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19884 below, following the list of private options.
19887 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19889 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19890 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19892 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19893 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19895 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19896 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19897 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19898 of the following values:
19907 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19908 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19909 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19912 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19913 router only if &%more%& is true.
19915 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19916 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19917 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19918 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19920 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19921 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19922 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19925 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19926 .cindex "randomized host list"
19927 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19928 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19929 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19930 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19931 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19932 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19933 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19934 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19936 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19937 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19938 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19939 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19941 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19943 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19944 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19945 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19946 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19947 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19950 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19951 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19952 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19955 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19957 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19958 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19962 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19963 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19964 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19965 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19968 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19969 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19970 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19971 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19972 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19973 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19974 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19975 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19977 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19978 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19979 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19980 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19981 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19982 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19983 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19984 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19989 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19990 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19991 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19992 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19993 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19994 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19996 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19998 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20002 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20003 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20005 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20006 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20007 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20008 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20009 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20010 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20011 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20012 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20013 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20014 in a &%route_list%&).
20016 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20017 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20018 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20019 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20023 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20024 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20025 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20026 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20027 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20028 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20029 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20032 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20033 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20035 This data can be accessed by setting
20037 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20039 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20040 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20041 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20042 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20043 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20048 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20049 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20050 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20051 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20052 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20053 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20054 The format of each item
20055 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20056 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20058 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20059 variables are set during its expansion:
20062 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20063 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20064 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20066 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20069 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20071 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20074 .vindex "&$value$&"
20075 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20076 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20078 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20082 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20083 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20087 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20088 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20089 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20090 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20091 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20092 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20095 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20096 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20097 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20099 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20100 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20103 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20104 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20105 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20106 number follows. For example:
20108 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20112 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20113 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20114 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20115 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20116 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20119 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20120 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20121 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20122 records in the DNS. For example:
20124 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20126 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20129 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20131 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20132 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20133 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20134 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20135 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20136 happens is controlled by the
20137 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20138 &%self%& option of the router.
20140 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20141 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20142 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20143 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20144 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20145 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20146 defined by MX preferences.
20148 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20149 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20150 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20152 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20153 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20154 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20155 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20157 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20158 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20161 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20162 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20163 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20165 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20166 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20170 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20171 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20172 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20173 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20174 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20175 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20176 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20179 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20180 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20182 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20183 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20185 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20186 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20187 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20189 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20190 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20191 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20193 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20195 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20200 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20201 domain2 host4:host5
20203 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20204 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20205 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20206 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20209 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20210 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20211 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20212 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20215 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20216 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20221 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20222 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20225 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20226 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20230 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20231 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20232 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20235 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20236 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20237 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20238 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20240 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20242 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20243 your first router something like this:
20246 driver = manualroute
20247 domains = !+local_domains
20248 transport = remote_smtp
20249 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20251 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20252 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20253 they are tried in order
20254 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20255 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20258 driver = manualroute
20259 transport = remote_smtp
20260 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20262 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20263 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20264 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20265 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20266 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20267 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20268 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20269 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20272 .cindex "mail hub example"
20273 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20274 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20275 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20276 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20277 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20278 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20279 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20280 lookup is easier to manage.
20282 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20283 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20287 driver = manualroute
20288 transport = remote_smtp
20289 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20291 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20292 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20293 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20294 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20295 domain can be used to find the host:
20298 driver = manualroute
20299 transport = remote_smtp
20300 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20302 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20303 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20304 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20308 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20309 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20310 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20311 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20312 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20313 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20316 driver = manualroute
20317 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20318 route_list = saved.domain.example
20320 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20321 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20322 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20325 driver = manualroute
20327 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20328 *.saved.domain2.example \
20329 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20332 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20334 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20335 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20336 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20337 the address if the lookup fails.
20340 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20341 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20342 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20343 one way it can be done:
20349 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20350 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20351 return_fail_output = true
20356 driver = manualroute
20358 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20360 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20362 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20364 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20365 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20366 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20368 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20369 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20379 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20381 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20382 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20383 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20384 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20385 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20386 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20387 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20388 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20389 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20390 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20392 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20394 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20395 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20396 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20397 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20398 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20401 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20402 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20403 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20404 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20405 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20406 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20409 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20410 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20411 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20412 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20413 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20414 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20415 not set, a value for the gid also.
20417 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20418 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20419 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20420 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20421 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20422 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20426 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20427 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20428 before running the command.
20431 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20432 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20433 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20437 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20438 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20439 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20440 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20441 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20444 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20447 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20448 &%no_more%& is set.
20450 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20451 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20452 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20453 included in the SMTP response.
20455 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20456 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20457 included in any SMTP response.
20459 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20461 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20462 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20464 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20465 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20466 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20469 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20470 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20473 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20474 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20476 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20477 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20478 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20479 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20481 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20482 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20483 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20484 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20485 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20487 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20488 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20489 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20490 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20491 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20493 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20494 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20495 variable. For example, this return line
20497 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20499 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20500 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20501 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20502 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20510 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20511 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20512 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20513 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20514 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20515 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20516 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20517 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20518 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20519 redirected in several different ways:
20522 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20525 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20527 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20529 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20531 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20533 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20535 It can be discarded.
20538 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20539 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20540 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20541 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20543 If success DSNs have been requested
20544 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20545 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20546 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20550 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20551 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20552 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20553 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20554 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20555 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20559 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20561 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20562 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20563 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20564 cause delivery to be deferred.
20566 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20567 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20572 file = $home/.forward
20575 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20576 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20577 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20578 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20583 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20584 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20585 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20586 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20589 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20590 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20591 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20592 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20594 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20595 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20596 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20597 saves some resources.
20605 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20606 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20607 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20608 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20609 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20612 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20613 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20614 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20615 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20616 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20617 document is intended for use by end users.
20619 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20620 described in the next section.
20623 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20624 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20625 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20626 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20627 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20631 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20632 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20633 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20634 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20635 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20636 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20637 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20638 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20639 commas or newlines.
20640 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20643 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20644 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20645 next newline character is ignored.
20647 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20648 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20649 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20650 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20653 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20654 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20655 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20656 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20657 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20658 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20661 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20665 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20666 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20667 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20668 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20669 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20670 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20671 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20672 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20673 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20674 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20675 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20677 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20678 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20679 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20680 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20681 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20683 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20685 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20686 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20687 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20688 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20689 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20692 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20693 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20694 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20695 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20696 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20698 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20699 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20704 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20705 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20708 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20710 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20711 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20712 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20713 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20714 should really contain
20716 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20718 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20719 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20720 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20724 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20725 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20726 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20729 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20730 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20731 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20732 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20733 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20734 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20735 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20737 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20738 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20739 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20740 in double quotes, for example:
20742 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20744 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20745 quote just the command. An item such as
20747 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20749 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20751 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20752 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20753 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20754 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20755 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20756 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20757 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20758 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20759 an &%accept%& router.
20762 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20763 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20764 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20765 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20767 /home/world/minbari
20769 is treated as a filename, but
20771 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20773 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20774 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20775 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20776 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20778 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20779 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20781 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20782 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20783 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20784 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20787 .cindex "included address list"
20788 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20789 If an item is of the form
20791 :include:<path name>
20793 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20794 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20795 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20796 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20797 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20798 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20800 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20802 It must be given as
20804 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20807 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20808 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20809 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20810 .cindex "black hole"
20811 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20812 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20813 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20814 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20818 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20819 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20820 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20822 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20823 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20824 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20825 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20829 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20830 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20831 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20832 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20833 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20834 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20835 redirection items of the form
20840 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20841 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20842 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20843 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20845 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20847 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20849 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20850 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20852 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20853 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20854 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20856 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20857 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20858 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20859 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20860 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20861 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20862 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20863 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20864 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20867 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20868 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20869 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20870 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20872 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20873 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20874 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20875 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20876 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20878 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20879 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20880 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20881 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20882 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20886 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20887 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20888 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20889 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20890 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20891 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20892 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20896 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20897 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20898 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20899 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20900 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20901 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20902 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20903 aliasing scheme of the type
20905 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20909 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20910 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20911 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20914 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20915 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20917 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20918 the pipes are distinct.
20922 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20923 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20924 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20925 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20926 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20927 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20928 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20929 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20930 can be used to avoid this.
20933 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20934 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20935 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20936 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20937 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20938 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20939 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20943 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20945 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20946 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20949 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20950 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20951 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20954 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20955 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20956 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20957 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20960 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20961 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20962 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20963 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20964 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20965 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20966 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20968 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20969 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20972 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20973 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20974 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20975 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20976 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20980 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20981 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20982 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20983 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20984 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20985 let ordinary users do.
20989 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20990 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20991 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20992 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20993 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20994 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20996 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20997 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20998 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20999 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21000 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21001 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21003 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21005 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21006 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21007 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21008 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21009 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21010 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21011 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21012 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21015 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21016 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21017 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21018 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21019 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21020 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21021 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21022 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21026 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21027 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21028 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21029 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21030 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21031 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21034 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21035 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21036 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21037 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21038 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21039 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21041 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21042 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21043 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21045 data = #Exim filter\n\
21046 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21048 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21049 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21050 choice into a newline.
21053 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21054 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21055 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21056 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21057 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21060 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21061 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21062 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21063 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21064 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21065 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21066 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21067 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21069 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21070 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21071 runs a check on the containing directory,
21072 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21073 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21074 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21075 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21076 not, the router declines.
21079 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21080 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21081 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21082 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21083 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21084 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21085 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21088 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21089 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21090 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21091 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21092 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21095 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21096 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21097 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21098 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21102 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21103 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21104 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21105 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21106 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21111 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21112 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21113 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21114 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21115 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21116 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21117 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21118 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21119 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21120 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21121 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21124 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21125 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21126 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21127 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21128 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21131 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21132 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21133 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21134 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21135 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21136 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21138 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21139 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21140 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21141 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21142 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21143 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21144 &_.forward_& files).
21147 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21148 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21149 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21150 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21151 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21154 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21155 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21156 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21157 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21158 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21159 of the embedded Perl support.
21162 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21163 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21164 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21165 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21166 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21169 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21170 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21171 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21172 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21173 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21176 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21177 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21178 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21179 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21180 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21181 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21182 &%one_time%& is set.
21185 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21186 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21187 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21188 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21189 to make use of &%run%& items.
21192 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21193 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21194 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21195 If this option is true, items of the form
21197 :include:<path name>
21199 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21202 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21203 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21204 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21205 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21206 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21207 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21208 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21211 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21212 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21213 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21214 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21215 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21218 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21219 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21220 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21221 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21222 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21227 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21228 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21229 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21230 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21231 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21232 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21233 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21236 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21238 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21239 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21240 file did not exist.
21243 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21245 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21246 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21247 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21249 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21250 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21251 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21252 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21253 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21254 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21255 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21256 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21260 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21261 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21262 redirection list must start with this directory.
21265 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21266 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21267 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21270 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21271 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21272 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21273 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21274 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21275 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21276 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21277 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21278 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21279 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21280 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21281 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21282 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21283 before they subscribed.
21285 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21286 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21287 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21288 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21291 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21292 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21293 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21294 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21296 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21297 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21298 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21300 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21303 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21304 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21305 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21306 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21307 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21311 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21312 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21313 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21314 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21315 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21316 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21317 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21318 See &%check_owner%& above.
21321 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21322 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21323 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21324 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21327 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21328 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21329 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21330 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21331 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21332 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21333 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21336 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21337 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21338 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21339 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21340 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21341 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21342 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21343 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21345 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21346 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21347 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21350 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21351 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21352 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21353 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21354 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21355 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21356 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21357 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21358 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21359 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21362 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21363 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21364 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21365 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21366 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21367 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21370 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21371 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21372 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21373 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21374 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21375 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21378 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21379 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21380 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21381 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21382 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21385 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21386 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21387 :subaddress part of an address.
21389 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21390 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21391 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21392 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21395 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21396 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21397 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21398 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21399 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21400 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21401 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21405 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21406 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21407 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21408 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21409 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21410 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21411 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21412 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21413 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21414 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21415 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21416 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21417 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21418 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21419 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21420 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21422 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21423 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21424 the following routers.
21426 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21427 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21428 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21429 so it is passed to the following routers.
21431 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21432 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21433 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21434 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21436 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21437 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21438 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21439 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21445 file = $home/.forward
21446 file_transport = address_file
21447 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21448 reply_transport = address_reply
21451 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21452 syntax_errors_text = \
21453 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21454 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21455 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21456 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21457 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21458 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21459 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21460 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21461 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21462 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21464 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21465 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21466 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21471 local_part_prefix = real-
21472 transport = local_delivery
21474 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21475 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21477 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21478 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21482 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21483 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21486 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21487 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21488 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21489 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21499 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21500 "Environment for local transports"
21501 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21502 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21503 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21504 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21505 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21506 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21507 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21509 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21510 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21511 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21512 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21514 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21515 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21516 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21517 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21518 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21522 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21523 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21524 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21525 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21526 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21527 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21528 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21531 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21532 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21536 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21538 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21539 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21540 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21541 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21546 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21547 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21548 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21549 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21550 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21551 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21552 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21553 group (set by the transport). For example:
21556 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21560 transport = group_delivery
21563 # This transport overrides the group
21565 driver = appendfile
21566 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21569 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21570 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21571 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21574 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21575 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21576 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21577 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21578 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21579 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21581 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21582 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21583 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21584 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21585 original gid is also used.
21587 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21588 following that is set is used:
21591 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21593 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21595 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21596 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21598 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21600 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21601 the uid is the creator's uid;
21603 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21606 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21607 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21608 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21609 The first of the following that is set is used:
21612 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21614 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21616 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21618 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21623 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21624 &%never_users%& list.
21630 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21631 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21632 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21633 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21634 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21635 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21636 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21637 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21638 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21639 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21642 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21644 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21646 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21648 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21651 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21654 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21656 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21660 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21661 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21662 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21666 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21667 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21668 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21669 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21670 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21671 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21672 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21673 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21674 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21675 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21676 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21677 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21678 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21679 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21690 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21691 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21692 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21693 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21694 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21697 .option body_only transports boolean false
21698 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21699 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21700 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21701 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21702 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21703 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21704 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21705 automatically suppress them.
21708 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21709 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21710 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21711 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21712 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21713 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21716 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21717 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21718 deliveries by the transport or for any
21719 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21720 what you are doing.
21723 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21724 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21725 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21726 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21728 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21729 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21730 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21731 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21732 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21733 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21735 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21736 transport and the router that called it.
21738 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21739 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21740 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21741 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21742 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21743 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21744 safely be resent to other recipients.
21747 .option driver transports string unset
21748 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21749 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21752 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21753 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21754 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21755 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21756 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21757 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21758 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21759 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21760 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21761 resent to other recipients.
21764 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21766 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21767 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21770 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21771 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21772 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21773 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21774 &%user%& (see below).
21777 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21778 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21779 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21780 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21781 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21782 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21783 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21784 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21785 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21786 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21787 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21789 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21790 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21793 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21794 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21795 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21796 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21797 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21798 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21799 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21800 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21803 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21804 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21805 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21806 This option specifies a list of header names,
21807 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21808 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21809 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21811 Each list item is separately expanded.
21812 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21813 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21814 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21816 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21817 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21819 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21820 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21821 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21825 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21826 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21827 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21828 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21829 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21830 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21831 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21832 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21835 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21838 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21839 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21840 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21841 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21842 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21843 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21844 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21845 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21846 change envelope recipients at this time.
21849 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21850 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21852 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21853 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21854 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21855 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21856 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21857 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21858 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21862 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21863 .cindex "additional groups"
21864 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21865 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21866 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21867 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21868 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21871 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21872 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21873 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21874 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21875 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21876 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21877 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21878 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21880 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21881 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21882 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21883 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21884 Obviously there is scope for
21885 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21886 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21888 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21889 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21890 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21891 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21892 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21895 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21896 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21897 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21898 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21899 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21900 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21901 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21902 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21903 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21904 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21905 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21906 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21907 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21912 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21913 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21914 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21915 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21916 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21917 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21918 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21919 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21922 local_part_prefix = *-
21924 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21927 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21929 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21930 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21931 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21932 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21933 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21936 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21937 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21938 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21939 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21940 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21941 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21942 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21943 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21944 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21946 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21947 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21948 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21949 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21951 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21952 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21953 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21956 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21957 .cindex "envelope sender"
21958 .cindex "envelope from"
21959 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21960 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21961 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21962 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21963 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21964 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21965 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21966 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21967 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21969 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21970 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21972 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21973 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21974 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21975 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21976 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21977 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21978 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21980 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21981 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21982 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21983 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21984 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21988 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21989 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21990 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21991 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21992 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21993 have easy access to it.
21995 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21996 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21997 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21998 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21999 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22003 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22004 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22007 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22008 .cindex "shadow transport"
22009 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22010 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22011 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22013 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22014 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22015 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22016 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22017 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22018 cause a log line to be written.
22020 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22021 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22022 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22023 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22024 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22027 ST=<shadow transport name>
22029 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22030 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22031 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22032 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22033 headers that some sites insist on.
22036 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22037 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22038 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22039 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22040 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22041 individual users or via a system filter.
22042 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22044 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22045 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22046 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22047 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22048 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22050 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22051 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22052 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22053 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22054 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22055 &(pipe)& transports.
22057 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22058 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22059 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22060 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22061 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22063 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22064 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22065 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22066 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22068 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22069 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22070 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22071 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22072 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22073 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22075 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22076 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22077 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22078 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22079 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22080 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22081 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22082 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22084 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22085 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22086 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22087 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22088 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22089 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22090 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22091 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22092 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22093 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22096 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22097 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22098 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22099 which the message is being sent. For example:
22101 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22102 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22105 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22106 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22107 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22109 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22110 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22111 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22114 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22116 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22117 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22118 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22119 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22120 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22121 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22123 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22124 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22125 arguments. Consider this example:
22127 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22128 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22130 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22131 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22133 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22134 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22138 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22139 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22140 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22141 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22142 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22143 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22144 bounced from a transport filter.
22146 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22147 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22148 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22151 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22152 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22153 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22154 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22155 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22156 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22157 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22158 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22159 becomes a temporary error.
22162 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22163 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22164 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22165 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22166 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22167 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22168 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22171 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22172 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22173 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22175 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22176 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22177 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22178 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22180 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22181 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22182 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22192 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22194 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22195 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22196 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22197 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22198 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22199 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22200 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22202 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22203 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22204 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22205 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22206 local transport, for example:
22209 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22210 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22211 recipients saves space.
22213 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22214 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22216 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22217 to a scanner program or
22218 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22222 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22223 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22224 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22226 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22227 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22228 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22229 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22230 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22231 to certain conditions:
22234 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22235 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22236 batching is possible.
22238 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22239 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22240 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22242 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22243 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22244 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22245 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22246 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22249 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22250 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22251 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22255 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22256 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22257 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22258 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22259 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22260 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22261 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22264 escape_string = ".."
22266 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22267 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22268 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22270 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22271 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22272 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22273 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22274 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22275 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22277 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22278 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22279 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22280 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22281 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22282 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22283 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22284 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22285 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22293 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22294 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22295 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22296 .cindex "directory creation"
22297 .cindex "creating directories"
22298 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22299 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22300 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22301 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22302 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22303 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22304 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22305 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22306 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22307 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22309 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22310 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22311 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22314 .cindex "quota" "system"
22315 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22316 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22317 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22319 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22320 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22321 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22322 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22324 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22325 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22328 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22329 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22330 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22331 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22336 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22337 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22338 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22339 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22340 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22342 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22343 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22344 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22345 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22346 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22347 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22348 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22349 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22350 operation. There are two cases:
22353 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22354 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22355 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22356 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22357 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22358 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22359 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22361 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22362 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22363 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22367 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22368 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22369 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22370 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22375 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22377 require "fileinto";
22378 fileinto "folder23";
22380 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22381 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22382 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22383 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22384 way of handling this requirement:
22386 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22387 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22388 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22390 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22394 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22395 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22396 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22398 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22399 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22400 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22401 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22402 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22403 path to the transport.
22405 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22406 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22411 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22412 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22416 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22417 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22418 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22419 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22420 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22421 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22422 delivery is deferred.
22425 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22426 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22427 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22428 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22429 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22430 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22431 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22432 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22435 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22436 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22437 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22438 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22442 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22443 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22446 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22447 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22448 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22449 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22450 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22453 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22454 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22455 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22456 process is running.
22459 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22460 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22461 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22462 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22463 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22464 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22465 contains is significant.
22467 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22468 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22469 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22470 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22471 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22473 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22474 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22475 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22476 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22477 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22478 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22480 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22481 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22482 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22483 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22485 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22486 .cindex "directory creation"
22487 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22488 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22489 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22491 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22492 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22493 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22494 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22495 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22499 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22500 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22501 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22502 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22503 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22506 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22507 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22508 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22509 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22510 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22511 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22512 &%file_must_exist%&.
22515 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22516 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22517 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22518 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22520 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22521 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22522 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22523 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22524 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22527 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22529 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22530 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22531 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22532 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22534 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22536 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22537 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22541 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22542 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22543 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22546 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22547 See &%check_string%& above.
22550 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22551 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22552 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22553 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22554 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22555 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22558 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22559 .cindex "locking files"
22560 .cindex "lock files"
22561 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22562 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22564 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22565 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22568 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22569 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22572 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22573 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22574 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22575 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22576 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22577 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22581 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22582 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22583 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22584 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22585 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22586 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22587 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22588 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22589 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22592 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22593 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22595 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22596 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22597 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22598 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22599 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22600 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22601 delivery is deferred.
22604 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22605 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22606 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22607 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22610 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22611 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22612 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22613 .cindex "locking files"
22614 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22615 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22616 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22617 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22618 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22619 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22620 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22621 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22623 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22624 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22625 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22626 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22628 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22629 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22632 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22634 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22635 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22636 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22638 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22639 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22641 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22644 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22645 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22646 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22647 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22650 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22651 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22652 for details of locking.
22655 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22656 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22657 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22660 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22661 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22662 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22665 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22666 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22667 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22668 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22669 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22672 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22673 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22674 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22675 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22676 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22677 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22678 external source that maintains the data.
22681 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22682 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22683 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22684 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22685 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22686 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22687 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22688 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22692 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22693 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22694 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22695 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22696 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22697 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22698 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22699 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22700 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22701 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22704 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22705 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22706 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22707 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22708 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22709 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22710 calculation. The default value is:
22712 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22714 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22715 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22717 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22719 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22721 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22722 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22723 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22724 directly into that directory.
22727 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22728 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22729 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22732 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22733 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22734 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22737 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22738 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22739 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22740 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22741 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22742 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22743 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22744 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22746 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22747 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22748 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22749 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22750 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22751 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22752 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22753 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22754 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22755 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22758 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22759 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22760 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22761 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22762 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22763 below for further details.
22766 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22767 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22768 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22771 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22772 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22773 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22776 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22777 .cindex "locking files"
22778 .cindex "file" "locking"
22779 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22780 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22781 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22782 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22783 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22784 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22785 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22787 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22788 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22789 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22796 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22797 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22798 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22799 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22800 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22801 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22802 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22803 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22805 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22806 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22807 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22808 append messages to it.
22811 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22812 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22813 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22814 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22815 in which case it is:
22817 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22818 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22820 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22821 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22823 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22824 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22825 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22826 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22831 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22832 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22834 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22835 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22836 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22837 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22838 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22839 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22840 value, and this option is ignored.
22843 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22844 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22845 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22846 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22847 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22850 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22851 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22852 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22853 on users about incoming mail.
22856 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22857 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22858 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22859 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22860 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22861 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22862 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22863 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22864 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22866 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22867 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22868 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22870 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22871 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22872 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22873 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22874 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22875 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22877 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22878 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22879 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22880 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22881 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22884 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22885 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22887 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22889 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22890 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22891 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22892 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22893 system quota failures.
22895 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22896 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22897 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22898 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22899 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22900 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22901 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22902 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22903 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22904 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22907 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22908 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22909 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22910 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22911 delivery directory.
22914 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22915 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22916 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22917 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22918 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22921 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22922 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22924 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22925 See &%quota%& above.
22928 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22929 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22930 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22931 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22932 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22933 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22934 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22936 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22937 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22938 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22939 the file length to the filename. For example:
22941 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22942 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22944 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22945 number of lines in the message.
22947 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22948 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22949 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22951 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22954 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22955 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22956 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22957 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22958 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22959 as is used to adjust the effective size.
22963 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22964 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22965 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22967 quota_warn_message = "\
22968 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22969 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22970 This message is automatically created \
22971 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22972 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22973 a warning threshold that is\n\
22974 set by the system administrator.\n"
22978 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22979 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22980 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22981 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22982 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22983 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22984 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22985 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22986 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22990 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22992 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22993 percent sign is ignored.
22995 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22996 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22997 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22998 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22999 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23000 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23002 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23004 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23005 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23008 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23009 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23013 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23014 .cindex "envelope from"
23015 .cindex "envelope sender"
23016 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23017 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23018 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23019 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23020 for details of batch SMTP.
23023 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23024 .cindex "carriage return"
23026 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23027 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23028 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23029 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23031 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23032 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23033 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23034 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23035 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23036 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23039 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23040 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23041 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23042 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23043 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23044 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23047 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23048 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23049 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23050 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23051 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23053 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23054 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23055 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23056 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23058 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23059 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23060 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23061 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23062 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23065 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23066 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23069 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23070 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23071 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23072 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23073 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23074 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23075 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23077 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23078 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23079 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23080 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23083 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23084 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23085 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23088 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23089 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23090 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23091 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23092 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23093 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23094 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23095 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23096 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23098 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23099 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23100 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23101 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23106 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23107 .cindex "appending to a file"
23108 .cindex "file" "appending"
23109 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23112 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23116 .cindex "directory creation"
23117 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23118 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23119 &%directory_mode%& option.
23122 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23123 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23127 .cindex "file" "locking"
23128 .cindex "locking files"
23129 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23130 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23131 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23134 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23135 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23136 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23138 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23140 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23141 Unlink the hitching post name.
23143 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23144 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23145 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23146 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23148 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23149 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23150 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23151 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23152 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23153 it before trying again.
23157 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23158 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23159 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23162 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23163 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23164 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23165 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23166 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23167 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23168 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23169 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23170 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23174 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23175 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23176 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23177 delivery is deferred.
23180 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23181 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23182 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23186 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23187 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23188 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23191 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23192 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23193 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23196 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23197 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23198 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23199 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23200 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23201 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23202 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23203 that prevents link following.
23206 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23207 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23208 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23209 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23210 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23213 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23216 .cindex "file" "locking"
23217 .cindex "locking files"
23218 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23219 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23220 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23221 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23222 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23224 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23226 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23227 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23228 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23230 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23231 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23232 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23234 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23235 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23236 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23237 delivery is deferred.
23239 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23240 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23241 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23242 immediately. It retries up to
23244 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23246 times (rounded up).
23249 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23250 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23253 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23254 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23255 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23256 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23257 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23258 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23259 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23260 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23261 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23262 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23264 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23265 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23266 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23267 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23268 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23269 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23270 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23272 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23273 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23274 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23275 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23278 .cindex "maildir format"
23279 .cindex "mailstore format"
23280 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23281 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23282 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23283 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23284 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23286 .cindex "directory creation"
23287 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23288 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23289 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23290 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23291 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23292 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23297 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23298 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23299 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23300 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23301 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23302 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23303 &_new_& subdirectory.
23305 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23306 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23307 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23308 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23309 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23310 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23311 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23313 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23314 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23315 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23316 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23317 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23318 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23319 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23320 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23322 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23323 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23324 folders. Consider this example:
23326 maildir_format = true
23327 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23328 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23329 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23330 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23332 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23333 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23334 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23335 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23336 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23337 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23339 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23340 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23341 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23342 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23343 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23345 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23346 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23347 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23349 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23350 .cindex "maildir++"
23351 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23352 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23353 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23354 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23355 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23356 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23357 amount of space used.
23359 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23360 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23361 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23362 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23363 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23364 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23369 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23370 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23371 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23372 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23373 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23374 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23377 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23378 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23379 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23380 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23381 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23382 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23383 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23384 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23385 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23386 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23387 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23388 backwards compatibility).
23390 For one common implementation, you might set:
23392 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23394 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23396 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23397 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23398 &[stat()]& each message file.
23401 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23402 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23403 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23404 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23405 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23406 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23407 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23408 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23409 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23411 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23412 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23413 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23414 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23415 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23416 need to know the quota.
23418 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23419 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23421 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23422 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23423 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23427 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23428 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23429 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23430 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23431 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23432 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23433 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23434 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23436 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23437 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23438 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23439 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23440 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23441 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23443 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23444 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23445 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23446 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23447 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23448 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23450 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23451 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23452 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23453 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23456 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23457 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23458 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23459 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23460 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23462 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23464 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23465 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23466 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23467 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23468 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23475 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23478 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23479 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23480 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23481 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23482 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23483 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23484 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23485 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23487 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23488 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23489 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23490 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23491 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23494 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23495 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23496 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23497 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23498 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23500 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23501 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23502 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23503 transport is run as a consequence of a
23505 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23506 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23507 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23508 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23509 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23510 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23512 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23513 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23514 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23515 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23517 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23518 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23519 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23520 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23521 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23522 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23523 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23525 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23526 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23527 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23528 the transport defers.
23529 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23530 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23532 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23533 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23534 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23535 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23537 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23538 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23539 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23540 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23541 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23542 problems. They are just discarded.
23546 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23547 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23549 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23550 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23551 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23554 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23555 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23556 when the message is specified by the transport.
23559 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23560 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23561 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23562 string comes first.
23565 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23566 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23567 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23570 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23571 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23572 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23575 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23576 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23577 specified by the transport.
23580 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23581 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23582 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23583 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23586 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23587 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23588 the message is specified by the transport.
23591 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23592 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23596 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23597 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23598 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23599 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23600 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23604 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23605 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23606 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23607 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23609 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23610 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23611 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23612 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23613 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23614 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23615 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23618 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23619 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23620 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23621 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23622 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23624 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23625 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23626 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23627 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23628 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23629 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23632 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23633 See &%once%& above.
23636 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23637 See &%once%& above.
23638 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23641 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23642 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23643 specified by the transport.
23646 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23647 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23648 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23649 configuration option.
23652 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23653 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23654 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23655 automatic responses. For example:
23657 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23659 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23660 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23661 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23662 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23667 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23668 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23669 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23670 the text comes first.
23673 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23674 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23675 when the message is specified by the transport.
23676 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23677 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23685 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23686 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23687 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23688 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23689 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23690 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23692 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23693 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23694 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23695 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23696 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23697 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23701 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23702 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23703 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23706 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23707 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23710 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23711 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23712 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23713 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23714 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23717 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23718 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23719 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23720 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23721 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23722 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23725 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23726 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23727 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23728 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23729 in its response to the LHLO command.
23731 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23732 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23733 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23734 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23737 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23738 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23739 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23740 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23745 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23749 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23750 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23757 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23758 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23759 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23760 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23761 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23762 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23763 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23764 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23768 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23769 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23770 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23771 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23772 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23774 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23775 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23776 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23777 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23778 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23779 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23780 that are routed to the transport.
23782 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23783 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23784 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23785 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23786 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23787 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23788 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23792 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23793 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23794 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23796 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23797 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23798 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23799 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23800 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23801 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23802 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23805 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23806 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23807 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23808 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23809 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23810 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23811 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23816 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23817 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23818 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23819 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23820 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23821 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23822 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23823 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23824 &"local delivery failed"&.
23826 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23827 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23828 will be sent as normal.
23830 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23831 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23832 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23833 apply in this case.
23835 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23836 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23837 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23838 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23840 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23841 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23842 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23843 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23844 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23845 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23846 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23851 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23852 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23853 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23854 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23855 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23858 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23859 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23860 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23861 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23863 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23864 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23865 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23866 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23867 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23869 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23871 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23872 arguments. You have to write
23874 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23876 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23877 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23878 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23879 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23880 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23881 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23884 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23887 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23888 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23889 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23890 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23891 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23892 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23893 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23894 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23895 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23896 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23897 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23899 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23900 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23901 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23902 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23903 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23904 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23905 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23906 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23908 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23909 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23910 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23911 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23912 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23913 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23914 control what is done with it.
23916 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23917 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23918 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23919 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23920 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23921 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23922 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23923 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23924 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23925 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23926 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23930 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23931 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23932 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23933 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23934 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23935 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23936 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23937 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23939 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23940 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23941 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23942 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23943 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23944 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23945 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23946 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23947 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23948 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23949 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23950 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23951 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23952 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23953 &`USER `& see below
23955 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23956 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23957 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23958 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23959 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23960 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23961 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23964 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23965 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23966 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23970 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23971 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23972 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23973 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23976 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23977 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23981 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23982 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23983 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23984 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23985 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23986 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23987 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23988 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23989 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23990 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23991 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23994 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23996 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23997 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23998 &%use_shell%& is set.
24001 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24002 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24005 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24006 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24007 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24010 .option check_string pipe string unset
24011 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24012 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24013 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24014 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24015 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24016 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24017 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24021 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24022 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24023 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24024 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24025 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24026 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24027 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24030 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24031 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24032 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24033 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24034 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24035 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24036 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24039 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24040 See &%check_string%& above.
24043 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24044 .cindex "exec failure"
24045 .cindex "failure of exec"
24046 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24047 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24048 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24049 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24050 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24053 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24054 .cindex "signal exit"
24055 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24056 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24057 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24058 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24061 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24062 .cindex "force command"
24063 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24064 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24065 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24066 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24067 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24068 command. For example:
24070 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24074 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24075 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24076 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24079 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24080 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24081 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24082 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24083 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24084 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24086 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24087 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24090 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24091 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24092 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24093 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24094 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24095 written to the main log.
24098 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24099 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24100 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24101 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24102 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24103 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24107 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24108 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24109 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24110 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24111 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24114 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24115 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24116 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24117 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24118 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24119 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24120 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24121 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24124 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24125 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24126 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24129 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24133 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24134 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24135 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24136 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24137 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24142 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24143 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24146 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24147 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24148 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24149 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24153 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24154 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24157 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24158 This option is expanded and
24159 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24160 variable of the subprocess.
24161 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24162 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24163 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24166 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24167 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24168 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24169 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24170 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24171 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24172 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24173 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24174 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24177 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24178 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24179 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24180 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24181 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24182 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24183 accept the message is used.
24186 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24187 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24188 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24189 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24190 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24191 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24194 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24195 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24196 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24197 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24198 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24199 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24200 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24204 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24205 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24206 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24207 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24208 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24209 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24210 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24211 of them may be set.
24215 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24216 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24217 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24218 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24219 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24220 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24221 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24222 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24223 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24224 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24225 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24226 and 73, respectively.
24229 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24230 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24231 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24232 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24233 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24234 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24235 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24237 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24238 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24239 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24240 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24241 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24242 delivery to be deferred.
24244 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24245 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24248 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24249 .cindex "envelope sender"
24250 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24251 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24252 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24253 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24254 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24256 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24257 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24258 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24259 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24260 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24261 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24265 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24266 .cindex "carriage return"
24268 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24269 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24270 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24271 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24273 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24274 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24275 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24276 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24277 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24280 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24281 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24282 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24283 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24284 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24285 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24286 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24287 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24288 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24293 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24294 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24295 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24296 .cindex "external local delivery"
24297 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24298 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24299 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24300 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24301 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24302 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24303 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24304 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24305 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24306 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24311 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24315 check_string = "From "
24316 escape_string = ">From "
24325 transport = procmail_pipe
24327 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24328 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24329 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24330 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24331 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24332 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24334 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24338 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24339 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24342 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24343 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24346 local_delivery_cyrus:
24348 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24349 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24361 local_part_suffix = .*
24362 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24364 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24365 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24367 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24368 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24374 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24375 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24376 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24377 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24378 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24379 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24380 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24381 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24384 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24385 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24389 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24390 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24391 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24392 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24393 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24394 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24395 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24397 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24398 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24399 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24400 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24401 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24402 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24407 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24408 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24409 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24413 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24415 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24416 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24417 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24418 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24419 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24420 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24421 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24422 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24425 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24426 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24427 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24428 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24429 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24430 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24431 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24432 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24433 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24434 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24435 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24436 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24437 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24438 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24440 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24441 and will be removed in a future release.
24444 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24445 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24446 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24449 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24450 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24451 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24452 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24453 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24454 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24455 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24456 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24458 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24459 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24460 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24461 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24462 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24463 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24464 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24465 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24466 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24469 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24471 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24472 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24473 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24474 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24475 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24478 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24479 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24480 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24481 particular connection.
24483 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24484 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24485 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24486 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24488 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24489 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24490 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24492 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24494 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24495 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24497 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24498 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24502 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24503 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24504 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24505 authenticated as a client.
24508 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24509 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24510 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24511 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24514 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24515 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24516 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24517 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24518 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24519 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24520 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24523 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24524 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24525 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24526 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24527 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24528 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24529 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24533 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24534 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24535 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24536 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24537 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24538 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24539 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24540 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24541 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24542 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24543 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24544 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24545 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24546 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24549 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24550 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24551 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24552 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24555 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24556 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24557 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24558 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24559 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24560 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24561 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24562 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24563 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24564 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24565 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24566 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24567 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24568 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24569 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24570 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24571 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24572 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24575 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24576 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24577 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24578 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24579 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24582 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24583 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24584 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24585 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24586 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24587 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24589 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24590 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24591 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24592 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24593 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24594 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24595 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24596 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24600 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24601 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24602 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24603 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24604 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24607 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24608 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24609 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24610 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24614 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24615 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24616 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24617 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24618 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24619 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24620 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24621 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24626 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24627 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24628 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24629 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24630 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24631 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24632 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24633 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24634 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24638 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24639 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24640 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24641 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24642 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24643 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24644 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24646 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24647 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24648 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24649 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24650 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24653 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24654 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24655 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24656 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24657 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24658 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24659 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24660 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24662 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24663 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24664 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24665 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24666 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24667 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24669 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24670 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24671 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24672 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24673 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24675 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24676 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24677 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24678 copy of the message is sent.
24680 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24681 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24682 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24683 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24687 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24688 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24689 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24692 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24693 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24694 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24695 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24696 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24697 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24699 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24700 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24701 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24702 implementations of TLS.
24704 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24705 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24706 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24707 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24708 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24709 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24710 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24715 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24716 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24717 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24718 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24719 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24720 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24721 interface address, you could use this:
24723 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24724 {$primary_hostname}}
24726 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24729 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24730 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24731 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24732 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24733 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24734 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24736 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24737 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24738 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24739 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24741 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24742 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24743 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24744 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24745 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24746 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24747 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24749 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24750 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24751 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24752 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24753 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24754 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24755 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24758 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24759 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24762 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24763 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24764 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24765 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24766 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24767 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24768 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24769 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24770 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24771 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24774 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24775 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24776 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24777 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24780 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24781 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24782 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24783 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24784 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24785 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24787 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24788 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24789 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24790 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24791 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24793 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24796 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24797 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24799 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24800 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24801 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24802 You have been warned.
24806 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24807 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24808 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24809 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24811 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24812 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24813 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24814 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24815 to any host that matches this list.
24818 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24819 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24820 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24821 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24822 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24823 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24824 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24825 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24828 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24829 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24830 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24835 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24836 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24837 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24838 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24839 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24840 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24841 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24842 explanation of when this might be needed.
24845 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24846 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24847 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24848 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24849 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24850 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24851 message on the same session.
24854 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24855 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24856 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24857 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24858 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24859 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24864 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24865 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24866 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24867 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24868 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24871 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24872 .cindex "randomized host list"
24873 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24874 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24875 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24876 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24877 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24878 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24879 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24880 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24882 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24883 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24884 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24885 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24887 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24889 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24890 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24891 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24893 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24894 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24895 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24896 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24897 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24898 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24899 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24900 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24901 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24904 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24905 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24906 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24907 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24908 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24910 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24911 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24912 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24913 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24914 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24915 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24916 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24917 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24918 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24920 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24921 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24922 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24923 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24924 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24926 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24927 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24928 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24929 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24930 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24931 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24933 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24934 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24935 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24936 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24937 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24938 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24939 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24941 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24942 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24943 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24944 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24945 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24946 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24947 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24949 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24950 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24951 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24952 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24953 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24954 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24955 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24956 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24957 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24959 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24960 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24961 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24962 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24963 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24964 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24965 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24966 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24967 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24968 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24970 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24971 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24973 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24974 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24975 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24976 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24977 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24979 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24980 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24981 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24982 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24983 for multi-recipient messages.
24984 The option can usually be left as default.
24986 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24987 .cindex "bind IP address"
24988 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24990 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24991 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24992 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24993 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24994 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24995 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24996 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24997 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25000 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25001 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25002 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25003 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25004 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25005 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25008 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25010 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25011 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25012 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25013 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25016 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25017 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25018 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25019 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25020 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25021 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25022 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25023 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25024 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25025 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25029 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25030 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25031 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25032 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25033 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25035 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25036 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25037 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25038 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25039 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25043 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25044 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25045 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25046 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25047 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25048 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25049 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25050 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25052 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25053 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25054 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25056 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25057 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25058 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25059 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25060 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25061 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25062 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25063 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25065 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25066 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25068 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25069 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25070 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25073 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25074 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25078 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25079 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25080 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25081 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25083 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25084 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25085 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25086 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25087 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25089 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25090 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25091 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25092 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25093 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25094 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25097 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25098 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25099 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25100 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25101 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25102 addresses is not affected.
25104 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25105 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25106 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25107 Exim to use only the host name.
25108 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25111 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25112 .cindex "serializing connections"
25113 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25114 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25115 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25116 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25117 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25118 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25119 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25121 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25122 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25123 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25124 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25125 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25126 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25128 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25129 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25130 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25131 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25132 are used for ETRN serialization.
25134 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25137 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25138 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25139 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25140 .cindex "size" "of message"
25141 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25142 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25143 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25144 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25145 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25146 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25147 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25148 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25150 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25151 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25154 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25155 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25156 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25157 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25160 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25161 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25162 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25164 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25165 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25166 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25167 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25168 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25171 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25172 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25173 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25174 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25178 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25179 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25180 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25181 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25182 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25185 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25186 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25187 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25188 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25189 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25190 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25193 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25196 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25197 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25199 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25200 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25201 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25202 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25203 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25204 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25205 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25206 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25209 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25210 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25211 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25213 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25214 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25215 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25216 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25217 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25218 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25219 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25220 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25221 ciphers is a preference order.
25225 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25226 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25227 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25228 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25229 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25230 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25231 certificate and private key for the session.
25233 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25235 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25241 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25242 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25243 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25244 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25245 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25246 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25247 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25248 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25249 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25250 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25254 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25255 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25256 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25257 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25258 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25259 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25260 Note that unless the host is in this list
25261 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25262 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25263 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25264 certificate verification succeeds.
25267 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25268 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25269 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25270 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25271 while verifying the server certificate,
25272 checks will be included on the host name
25273 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25274 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25275 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25277 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25280 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25281 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25282 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25284 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25285 The value of this option must be either the
25287 or the absolute path to
25288 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25289 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25291 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25292 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25293 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25296 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25297 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25299 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25301 either by file or directory
25302 are added to those given by the system default location.
25304 The values of &$host$& and
25305 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25306 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25308 For back-compatibility,
25309 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25310 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25311 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25314 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25315 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25316 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25317 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25318 certificate verification must succeed.
25319 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25320 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25321 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25323 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25324 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25325 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25326 If built with internationalization support,
25327 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25329 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25334 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25336 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25337 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25338 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25339 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25340 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25343 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25344 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25345 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25346 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25349 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25350 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25351 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25353 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25354 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25355 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25356 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25357 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25359 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25360 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25361 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25362 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25363 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25364 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25365 see below for an exception).
25367 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25368 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25369 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25370 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25371 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25373 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25374 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25375 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25376 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25377 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25378 reached their retry times.
25380 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25381 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25382 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25383 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25384 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25385 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25386 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25387 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25388 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25389 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25392 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25393 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25394 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25395 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25396 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25397 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25399 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25400 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25401 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25402 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25403 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25404 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25410 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25413 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25414 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25415 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25416 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25417 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25418 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25420 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25421 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25422 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25423 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25424 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25425 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25426 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25428 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25429 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25430 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25431 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25434 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25435 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25436 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25437 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25439 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25440 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25441 facility; you do not have to use it.
25443 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25444 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25445 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25446 address to which it applies.
25448 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25449 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25450 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25451 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25452 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25453 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25456 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25457 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25458 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25459 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25462 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25463 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25464 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25465 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25466 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25469 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25470 illustrated by these examples:
25473 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25474 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25475 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25476 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25478 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25479 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25484 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25485 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25486 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25487 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25488 message's processing.
25490 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25491 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25492 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25493 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25494 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25495 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25496 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25497 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25498 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25500 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25501 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25502 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25503 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25504 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25505 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25506 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25507 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25508 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25509 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25511 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25512 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25513 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25514 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25515 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25516 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25518 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25519 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25520 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25522 .cindex "envelope from"
25523 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25524 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25525 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25526 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25527 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25528 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25529 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25530 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25531 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25533 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25534 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25540 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25541 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25542 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25543 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25544 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25545 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25546 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25547 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25548 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25549 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25551 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25553 might produce the output
25555 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25556 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25557 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25558 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25559 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25560 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25561 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25562 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25564 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25565 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25566 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25567 set for a particular transport.
25570 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25571 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25572 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25575 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25577 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25578 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25579 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25580 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25582 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25583 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25584 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25585 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25588 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25589 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25590 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25592 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25593 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25594 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25595 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25596 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25597 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25598 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25600 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25601 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25602 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25603 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25604 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25608 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25609 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25612 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25613 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25614 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25615 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25616 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25617 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25618 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25619 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25620 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25622 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25623 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25624 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25626 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25627 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25628 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25629 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25630 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25631 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25632 of pattern they are set as follows:
25635 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25636 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25637 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25640 *queen@*.fict.example
25642 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25644 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25648 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25649 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25652 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25653 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25654 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25655 rewriting rule of the form
25657 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25659 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25665 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25666 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25667 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25668 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25669 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25673 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25674 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25675 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25676 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25677 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25679 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25681 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25684 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25685 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25686 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25687 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25688 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25689 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25690 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25691 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25692 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25693 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25694 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25695 entry written to the panic log.
25699 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25700 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25703 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25706 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25708 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25711 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25712 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25716 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25718 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25719 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25720 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25721 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25722 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25723 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25725 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25726 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25727 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25728 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25729 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25730 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25731 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25732 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25733 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25734 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25736 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25737 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25738 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25740 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25741 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25744 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25745 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25746 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25747 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25748 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25749 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25750 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25751 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25752 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25754 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25755 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25756 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25757 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25758 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25759 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25760 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25761 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25764 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25765 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25766 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25767 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25770 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25771 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25772 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25774 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25775 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25776 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25777 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25779 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25780 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25781 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25783 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25784 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25785 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25786 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25788 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25792 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25795 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25796 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25797 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25798 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25799 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25800 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25801 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25802 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25804 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25805 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25809 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25810 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25812 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25813 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25814 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25816 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25817 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25818 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25819 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25820 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25821 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25822 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25823 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25825 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25826 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25828 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25830 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25831 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25833 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25834 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25835 messages that originate outside the local host:
25837 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25838 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25840 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25843 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25844 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25845 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25846 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25847 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25848 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25849 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25850 components. For example, the rule
25852 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25854 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25855 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25856 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25857 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25858 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25859 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25860 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25868 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25870 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25871 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25872 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25873 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25874 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25875 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25876 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25877 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25878 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25879 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25880 address, domain and error.
25882 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25883 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25884 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25885 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25886 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25887 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25888 log selector is set, the message
25889 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25890 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25891 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25892 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25894 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25895 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25896 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25897 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25898 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25899 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25900 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25901 domain are maintained independently.
25903 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25904 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25905 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25906 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25907 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25908 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25909 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25910 the local address is reached.
25912 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25913 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25914 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25915 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25916 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25918 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25919 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25920 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25921 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25922 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25923 messages that it should now be retaining.
25927 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25928 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25929 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25930 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25931 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25932 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25933 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25934 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25935 message's sender, respectively.
25938 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25939 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25940 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25941 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25942 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25943 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25946 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25948 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25951 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25953 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25954 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25957 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25958 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25959 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25960 expressions work in address lists.
25962 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25963 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25967 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25968 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25969 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25970 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25971 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25972 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25973 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25974 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25975 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25977 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25978 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25979 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25980 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25983 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25984 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25985 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25986 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25987 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25988 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25989 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25990 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25991 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25992 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25997 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25999 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26000 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26001 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26002 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26003 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26004 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26006 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26010 and the retry rules are
26012 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26013 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26015 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26016 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26017 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26018 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26019 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26020 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26022 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26023 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26024 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26025 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26027 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26028 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26029 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26031 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26033 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26034 textual form of the IP address.
26036 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26037 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26038 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26039 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26042 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26043 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26044 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26046 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26047 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26048 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26050 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26051 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26053 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26054 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26057 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26058 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26059 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26060 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26061 retry rule of this form:
26063 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26065 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26066 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26069 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26070 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26071 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26072 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26075 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26076 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26077 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26078 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26079 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26081 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26082 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26084 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26085 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26088 A connection was refused.
26090 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26091 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26093 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26094 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26096 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26097 A connection attempt timed out.
26099 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26100 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26101 obtained from an MX record.
26103 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26104 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26105 obtained from an MX record.
26108 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26110 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26111 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26112 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26113 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26116 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26119 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26120 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26121 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26122 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26123 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26124 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26128 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26129 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26130 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26131 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26132 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26136 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26137 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26138 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26140 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26141 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26142 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26143 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26144 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26145 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26146 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26148 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26149 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26152 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26153 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26154 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26159 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26160 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26161 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26162 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26163 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26166 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26168 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26170 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26172 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26173 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26176 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26178 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26179 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26180 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26181 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26182 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26184 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26185 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26187 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26189 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26190 list is never matched.
26196 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26197 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26198 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26199 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26201 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26203 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26204 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26205 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26206 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26207 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26209 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26210 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26211 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26212 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26213 The available algorithms are:
26216 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26219 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26220 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26221 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26223 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26224 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26225 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26226 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26227 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26228 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26229 queue processing times.
26232 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26233 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26234 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26235 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26236 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26237 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26238 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26239 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26240 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26241 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26242 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26243 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26245 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26246 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26247 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26248 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26249 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26250 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26253 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26254 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26255 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26256 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26257 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26258 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26259 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26260 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26261 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26262 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26263 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26264 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26266 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26267 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26268 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26269 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26270 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26271 deliveries that have been deferred.
26274 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26275 Here are some example retry rules:
26277 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26278 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26279 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26280 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26281 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26282 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26284 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26285 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26286 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26287 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26288 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26289 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26290 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26293 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26294 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26295 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26296 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26297 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26299 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26300 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26301 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26302 were not obtained from an MX record.
26304 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26305 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26306 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26307 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26308 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26312 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26313 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26314 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26315 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26316 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26317 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26318 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26319 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26320 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26321 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26322 failing for the first time.
26324 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26325 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26326 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26327 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26329 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26330 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26331 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26336 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26337 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26338 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26339 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26340 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26341 default retry rule:
26343 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26345 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26346 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26347 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26349 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26350 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26351 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26352 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26353 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26355 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26356 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26357 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26359 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26360 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26361 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26362 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26363 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26364 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26365 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26366 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26367 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26368 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26369 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26371 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26372 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26373 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26374 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26375 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26378 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26379 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26380 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26381 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26382 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26383 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26384 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26385 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26386 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26389 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26390 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26391 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26392 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26393 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26394 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26395 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26396 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26399 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26400 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26401 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26402 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26403 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26404 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26405 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26406 time out the address.
26408 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26409 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26410 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26411 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26412 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26413 considered immediately.
26414 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26415 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26425 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26426 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26427 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26428 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26429 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26430 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26431 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26432 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26433 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26436 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26437 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26440 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26441 the client's EHLO command.
26443 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26444 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26446 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26447 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26448 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26449 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26450 with the AUTH command.
26452 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26454 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26455 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26456 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26459 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26460 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26461 unauthenticated connection.
26464 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26465 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26466 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26467 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26469 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26470 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26471 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26472 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26473 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26474 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26475 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26476 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26481 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26482 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26483 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26484 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26485 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26486 included by setting
26489 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26493 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26498 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26499 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26500 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26501 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26502 work via a socket interface.
26504 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26505 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26507 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26508 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26509 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26510 supporting setting a server keytab.
26511 The seventh can be configured to support
26512 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26513 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26514 The eighth authenticator
26515 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26516 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26517 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26519 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26520 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26521 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26522 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26523 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26524 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26525 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26527 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26528 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26529 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26530 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26531 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26532 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26536 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26537 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26539 client_secret = secret2
26541 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26542 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26544 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26545 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26546 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26549 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26550 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26551 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26552 authenticating data.
26554 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26555 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26556 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26557 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26558 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26559 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26560 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26561 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26562 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26563 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26566 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26567 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26568 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26569 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26573 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26574 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26575 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26577 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26578 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26579 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26580 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26581 encrypted by a setting such as:
26583 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26587 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26588 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26589 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26590 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26593 .option driver authenticators string unset
26594 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26595 authenticators is to be used.
26598 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26599 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26600 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26601 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26602 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26603 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26606 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26607 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26608 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26609 mechanism is not advertised.
26610 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26611 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26612 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26615 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26616 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26617 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26620 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26621 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26623 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26624 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26625 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26626 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26627 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26628 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26629 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26630 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26631 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26635 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26636 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26637 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26638 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26639 out the values of variables.
26640 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26641 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26644 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26645 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26646 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26647 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26648 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26649 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26650 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26651 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26652 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26653 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26654 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26655 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26658 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26659 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26660 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26661 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26662 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26663 remembered for later use.
26664 How it is used is described in the following section.
26670 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26671 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26672 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26673 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26674 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26678 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26679 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26681 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26683 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26684 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26685 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26686 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26687 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26688 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26689 given for the MAIL command.
26691 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26692 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26695 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26696 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26697 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26698 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26699 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26700 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26701 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26706 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26707 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26708 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26709 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26711 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26712 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26713 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26714 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26715 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26720 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26721 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26722 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26723 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26727 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26729 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26730 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26733 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26734 the mechanisms are advertised.
26736 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26737 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26738 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26739 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26740 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26741 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26742 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26744 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26746 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26748 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26749 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26750 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26753 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26755 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26756 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26757 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26759 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26760 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26761 command. This is the case if
26764 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26766 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26768 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26769 server authenticators.
26773 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26774 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26775 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26777 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26778 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26779 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26780 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26781 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26782 rejected with a 504 error.
26784 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26785 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26786 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26787 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26788 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26789 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26790 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26791 no successful authentication.
26793 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26794 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26795 &%authresults%& expansion item.
26800 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26801 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26802 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26803 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26804 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26805 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26806 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26810 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26812 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26813 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26814 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26815 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26816 command line to run this script on such data might be
26818 encode '\0user\0password'
26820 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26821 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26822 whose code value is zero.
26824 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26825 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26826 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26827 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26829 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26830 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26831 example, a command such as
26833 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26835 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26837 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26838 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26840 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26842 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26843 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26844 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26845 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26849 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26850 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26851 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26852 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26853 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26854 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26857 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26858 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26859 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26860 of the authenticator.
26863 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26864 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26865 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26866 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26867 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26868 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26869 delivery to be deferred.
26871 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26872 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26873 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26876 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26877 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26878 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26879 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26880 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26881 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26882 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26883 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26884 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26887 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26888 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26889 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26890 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26891 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26892 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26893 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26894 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26896 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26898 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26899 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26900 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26901 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26902 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26903 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26904 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26905 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26906 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26907 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26908 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26909 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26910 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26920 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26921 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26922 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26923 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26924 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26925 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26926 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26927 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26928 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26929 connections as you do for login accounts.
26931 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26932 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26933 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26935 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26936 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26937 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26939 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26940 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26941 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26944 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26945 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26946 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26947 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26948 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26949 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26950 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26952 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26953 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26954 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26955 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26956 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26957 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26958 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26960 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26961 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26962 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26963 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26965 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26966 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26967 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26969 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26970 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26971 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26972 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26973 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26974 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26975 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26976 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26977 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26978 string as the error text.
26980 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26981 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26982 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26986 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26987 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26988 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26989 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26990 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26991 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26992 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26993 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26995 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26996 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26997 configured as follows:
27001 public_name = PLAIN
27003 server_condition = \
27004 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27005 server_set_id = $auth2
27007 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27008 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27009 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27010 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27012 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27013 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27014 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27015 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27019 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27021 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27023 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27024 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27028 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27029 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27031 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27032 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27033 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27034 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27035 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27037 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27038 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27039 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27041 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27042 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27043 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27044 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27045 This is an incorrect example:
27047 server_condition = \
27048 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27050 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27051 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27052 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27053 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27054 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27055 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27056 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27058 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27059 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27061 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27062 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27063 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27064 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27065 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27068 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27069 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27070 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27071 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27072 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27073 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27074 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27078 public_name = LOGIN
27079 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27080 server_condition = \
27081 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27082 server_set_id = $auth1
27084 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27085 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27086 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27087 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27089 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27090 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27091 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27092 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27093 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27097 public_name = LOGIN
27098 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27099 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27102 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27103 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27104 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27105 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27107 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27108 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27109 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27110 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27111 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27112 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27113 uninterpreted string.
27116 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27117 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27118 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27119 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27120 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27126 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27127 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27128 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27130 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27131 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27132 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27133 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27136 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27137 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27138 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27139 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27140 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27141 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27142 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27143 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27144 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27145 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27146 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27147 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27149 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27150 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27152 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27153 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27154 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27155 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27158 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27159 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27163 public_name = PLAIN
27164 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27166 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27167 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27168 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27172 public_name = LOGIN
27173 client_send = : username : mysecret
27175 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27176 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27178 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27179 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27187 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27188 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27189 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27190 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27191 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27192 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27193 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27194 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27195 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27196 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27197 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27198 available in plain text at either end.
27201 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27202 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27203 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27204 authenticator as a server:
27206 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27207 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27208 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27209 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27210 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27211 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27212 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27213 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27214 returned to the client.
27216 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27217 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27218 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27219 numeric variables for other things.
27221 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27222 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27223 user name, authentication fails.
27227 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27228 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27229 server_set_id = $auth1
27231 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27232 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27233 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27234 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27238 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27239 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27241 server_set_id = $auth1
27243 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27244 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27246 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27247 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27248 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27253 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27254 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27255 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27256 server_set_id = $auth1
27259 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27260 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27261 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27265 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27266 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27267 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27270 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27271 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27272 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27276 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27277 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27278 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27279 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27280 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27281 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27282 send the message to the current server.
27284 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27289 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27291 client_secret = secret
27293 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27294 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27298 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27299 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27301 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27302 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27303 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27304 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27306 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27307 at A L Digital Ltd.
27309 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27310 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27311 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27312 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27313 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27315 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27316 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27317 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27318 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27320 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27321 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27322 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27323 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27324 depending on the driver you are using.
27326 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27327 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27328 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27329 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27330 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27333 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27334 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27335 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27336 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27337 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27338 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27339 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27340 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27343 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27344 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27345 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27346 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27347 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27348 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27352 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27353 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27354 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27355 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27358 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27359 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27360 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27361 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27365 driver = cyrus_sasl
27366 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27367 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27368 server_set_id = $auth1
27371 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27372 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27375 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27376 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27379 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27380 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27381 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27382 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27385 driver = cyrus_sasl
27386 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27387 server_set_id = $auth1
27390 driver = cyrus_sasl
27391 public_name = PLAIN
27392 server_set_id = $auth2
27394 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27395 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27396 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27397 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27398 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27405 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27406 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27407 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27408 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27409 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27410 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27411 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27412 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27413 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27415 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27417 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27418 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27419 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27420 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27424 public_name = PLAIN
27425 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27426 server_set_id = $auth1
27431 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27432 server_set_id = $auth1
27434 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27435 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27436 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27437 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27438 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27439 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27440 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27441 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27445 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27446 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27447 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27448 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27449 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27450 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27451 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27452 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27453 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27454 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27455 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27456 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27457 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27458 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27459 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27460 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27461 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27462 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27463 without code changes in Exim.
27465 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27466 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27469 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27470 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27472 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27473 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27474 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27475 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27478 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27479 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27480 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27482 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27483 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27484 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27486 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27487 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27488 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27490 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27491 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27492 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27495 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27496 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27497 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27498 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27501 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27502 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27503 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27504 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27509 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27510 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27511 server_set_id = $auth1
27515 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27516 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27517 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27518 the password itself.
27520 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27521 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27522 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27523 if available, else the empty string.
27524 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27525 else the empty string.
27527 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27529 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27530 option to be simply "true".
27533 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27534 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27535 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27538 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27539 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27540 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27541 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27544 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27545 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27546 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27547 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27550 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27551 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27552 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27555 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27556 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27557 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27558 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27560 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27561 meanings for these variables:
27564 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27565 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27567 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27568 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27570 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27571 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27574 On a per-mechanism basis:
27577 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27578 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27579 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27581 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27582 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27583 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27585 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27586 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27587 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27588 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27591 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27592 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27593 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27596 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27597 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27599 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27601 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27602 server_realm = imap.example.org
27603 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27604 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27605 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27606 server_condition = yes
27610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27613 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27614 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27615 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27616 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27617 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27618 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27619 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27622 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27623 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27624 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27625 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27627 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27628 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27629 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27630 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27632 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27633 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27634 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27638 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27639 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27640 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27641 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27643 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27644 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27645 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27646 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27648 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27650 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27651 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27653 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27654 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27655 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27663 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27664 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27665 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27666 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27667 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27668 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27669 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27670 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27671 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27672 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27673 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27674 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27675 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27679 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27680 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27682 The server sends back a challenge.
27684 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27685 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27688 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27692 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27693 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27694 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27696 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27697 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27698 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27699 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27700 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27701 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27702 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27703 for other things. For example:
27708 server_password = \
27709 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27711 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27712 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27718 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27719 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27720 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27724 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27725 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27728 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27729 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27732 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27733 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27734 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27740 client_username = msn/msn_username
27741 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27742 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27744 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27745 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27754 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27755 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27756 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27757 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27758 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27759 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27760 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27761 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27762 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27763 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27764 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27765 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27766 by the server configuration.
27768 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27769 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27770 and for clients to only attempt,
27771 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27773 One possible use, compatible with the
27774 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27775 is for using X509 client certificates.
27777 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27778 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27779 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27780 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27781 client certificates only.
27783 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27784 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27786 The client must present a certificate,
27787 for which it must have been requested via the
27788 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27789 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27790 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27791 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27793 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27794 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27795 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27797 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27798 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27799 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27800 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27801 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27802 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27803 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27805 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27807 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27808 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27809 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27810 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27811 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27812 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27814 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27815 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27816 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27817 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27818 an identity for authentication and
27819 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27821 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27822 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27823 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27824 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27826 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27827 Once an identity has been received,
27828 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27829 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27830 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27831 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27832 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27833 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27834 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27835 string as the error text.
27839 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27841 public_name = EXTERNAL
27843 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27844 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27845 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27846 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27847 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27848 server_set_id = $auth1
27850 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27851 of your configured trust-anchors
27852 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27853 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27855 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27856 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27857 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27859 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27862 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27863 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27864 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27866 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27867 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27868 identity being asserted.
27874 public_name = EXTERNAL
27876 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27877 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27881 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27882 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27891 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27892 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27893 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27894 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27895 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27896 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27897 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27898 authentication based on client certificates.
27900 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27901 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27902 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27903 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27904 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27905 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27907 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27908 for which it must have been requested via the
27909 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27910 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27912 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27913 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27914 and can authenticate the connection.
27915 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27917 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27920 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27921 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27923 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27924 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27925 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27926 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27927 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27928 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27930 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27931 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27932 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27934 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27941 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27942 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27943 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27946 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27947 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27948 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27950 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27952 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27953 of your configured trust-anchors
27954 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27955 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27957 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27958 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27959 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27961 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27963 . An alternative might use
27965 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27967 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27968 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27969 . This would help for per-device use.
27971 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27972 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27974 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27975 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27978 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27979 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27980 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27987 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27988 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27989 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27990 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27991 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27994 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27995 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27996 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27997 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27998 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27999 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28000 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28001 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28002 certificates are used.
28004 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28005 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28006 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28007 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28008 between them is encrypted.
28010 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28011 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28012 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28013 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28016 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28017 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28018 in order to get TLS to work.
28022 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28024 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28025 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28026 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28027 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28028 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28029 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28030 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28031 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28032 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28033 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28034 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28036 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28037 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28038 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28040 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28041 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28042 reassigned for other use.
28043 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28045 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28046 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28047 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28049 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28050 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28051 the most common use is expected to be:
28053 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28055 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28056 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28057 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28058 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28059 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28062 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28063 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28070 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28071 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28072 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
28073 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
28074 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28079 you must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28080 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28082 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28085 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28086 cannot be the path of a directory
28087 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28088 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28090 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28092 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28093 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28094 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28095 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28096 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28098 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28099 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28100 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28101 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28102 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28103 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28104 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28107 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28108 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28110 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28111 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28112 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28113 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28115 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28116 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28118 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28119 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28120 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28121 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28125 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28126 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28127 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28128 but not the chosen filename.
28129 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28130 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28132 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28133 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28134 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28135 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28137 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28138 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28139 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28140 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28141 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28142 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28143 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28145 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28146 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28147 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28148 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28149 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28151 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28152 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28153 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28154 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28155 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28156 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28158 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28159 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28160 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28162 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28163 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28164 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28165 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28168 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28171 # chown exim:exim new-params
28172 # chmod 0600 new-params
28173 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28174 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28175 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28176 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28177 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28178 # chmod 0400 new-params
28179 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28181 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28182 stalling is removed.
28184 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28185 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28186 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28187 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28188 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28189 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28190 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28191 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28192 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28193 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28194 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28196 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28197 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28198 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28199 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28201 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28202 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28203 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28204 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28205 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28208 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28209 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28210 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28211 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28212 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28213 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28214 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28215 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28216 directly to this function call.
28217 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28218 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28219 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28220 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28223 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28225 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28226 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28227 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28230 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28231 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28232 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28236 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28239 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28240 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28243 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28244 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28246 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28247 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28250 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28251 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28252 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28253 not be moved to the end of the list.
28256 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28259 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28260 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28263 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28264 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28265 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28266 choice of clients used:
28268 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28269 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28274 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28276 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28279 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28280 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28281 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28282 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28284 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28286 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28290 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28292 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28293 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28294 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28295 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28296 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28297 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28298 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28299 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28300 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28301 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28303 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28304 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28306 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28307 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28308 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28309 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28310 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28311 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28313 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28314 "Priority strings". This is online as
28315 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28316 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28317 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28318 then the example code
28319 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28320 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28324 # Disable older versions of protocols
28325 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28328 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28329 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28330 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28332 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28333 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28334 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28335 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28339 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28345 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28346 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28347 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28348 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28349 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28350 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28351 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28353 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28354 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28356 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28357 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28358 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28361 554 Security failure
28363 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28364 rejected with a 554 error code.
28366 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28367 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28369 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28370 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28371 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28372 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28374 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28376 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28378 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28379 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28381 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28382 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28383 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28384 that goes with it. These files need to be
28385 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28386 always be given as full path names.
28387 The key must not be password-protected.
28388 They can be the same file if both the
28389 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28390 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28391 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28392 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28393 the server's certificate.
28395 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28396 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28397 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28398 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28399 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28400 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28402 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28403 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28404 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28406 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28407 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28408 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28411 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28412 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28413 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28415 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28417 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28418 with the parameters contained in the file.
28419 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28424 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28425 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28426 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28427 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28433 for a way of generating file data.
28435 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28436 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28437 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28438 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28439 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28441 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28442 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28443 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28444 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28445 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28446 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28447 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28448 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28449 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28451 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28452 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28453 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28454 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28455 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28456 documentation for more details.
28458 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28459 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28462 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28463 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28464 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28465 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28466 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28467 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28468 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28469 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28470 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28471 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28472 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28473 an explicit file or,
28474 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28475 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28477 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28480 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28481 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28482 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28484 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28486 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28488 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28489 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28491 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28492 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28493 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28494 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28495 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28496 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28497 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28498 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28499 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28500 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28502 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28503 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28504 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28505 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28507 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28508 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28509 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28510 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28511 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28512 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28515 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28516 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28517 .cindex "revocation list"
28518 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28519 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28520 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28521 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28522 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28523 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28524 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28526 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28527 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28529 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28530 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28531 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28532 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28533 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28534 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28536 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28537 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28538 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28539 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28541 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28542 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28543 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28544 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28545 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28546 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28547 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28548 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28550 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28551 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28552 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28554 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28555 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28556 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28557 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28558 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28560 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28561 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28562 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28563 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28564 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28567 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28568 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28571 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28572 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28573 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28574 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28575 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28576 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28578 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28579 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28581 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28584 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28585 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28586 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28588 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28589 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28590 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28596 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28597 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28598 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28599 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28600 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28601 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28602 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28603 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28604 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28606 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28607 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28608 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28609 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28610 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28612 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28613 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28614 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28615 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28616 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28619 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28620 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28621 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28622 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28623 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28624 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28625 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28626 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28627 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28628 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28631 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28632 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28633 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28634 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28637 Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28638 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28639 As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28640 in failed connections.
28643 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28644 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28646 the system default set (depending on library version),
28648 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28649 The client verifies the server's certificate
28650 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28651 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28652 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28653 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28655 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28656 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28657 or need not succeed respectively.
28659 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28660 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28661 is valid for the certificate.
28662 The option defaults to always checking.
28664 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28665 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28666 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28668 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28669 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28670 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28673 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28674 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28675 for OCSP to be relevant.
28678 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28679 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28680 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28681 alternative hosts, if any.
28684 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28685 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28686 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28690 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28691 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28692 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28693 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28694 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28696 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28697 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28698 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28699 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28700 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28701 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28702 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28703 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28704 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28705 outgoing connection.
28709 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28710 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28711 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28712 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28713 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28714 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28715 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28716 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28717 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28718 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28721 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28722 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28725 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28726 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28727 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28728 be of limited use in that environment.
28730 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28731 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28732 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28733 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28734 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28736 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28737 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28738 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28739 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28740 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28742 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28743 received from a client.
28744 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28746 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28747 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28748 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28751 &%tls_certificate%&
28757 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28762 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28763 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28764 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28765 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28766 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28767 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28768 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28770 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28773 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28774 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28775 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28776 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28778 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28779 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28780 built, then you have SNI support).
28784 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28786 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28787 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28788 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28789 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28790 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28791 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28792 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28793 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28794 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28795 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28797 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28798 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28799 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28800 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28801 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28802 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28803 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28805 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28806 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28807 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28808 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28809 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28810 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28811 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28812 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28813 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28815 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28816 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28817 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28818 information is recorded.
28820 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28821 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28822 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28827 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28828 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28829 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28830 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28831 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28832 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28834 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28835 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28836 document is currently at
28838 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28840 and their FAQ is at
28842 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28845 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28846 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28848 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28849 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28850 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28851 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28854 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28855 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28856 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28857 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28858 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28859 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28860 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28861 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28862 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28863 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28864 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28865 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28866 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28868 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28869 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28870 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28871 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28875 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28876 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28877 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28878 with OpenSSL, like this:
28879 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28880 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28882 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28885 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28886 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28887 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28888 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28889 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28890 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28891 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28893 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28894 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28895 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28896 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28897 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28898 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28900 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28901 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28902 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28903 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28904 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28905 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28906 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28907 be a sensible resolution).
28909 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28910 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28911 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28913 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28914 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28915 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28916 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28917 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28918 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28920 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28921 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28922 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28923 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28924 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28925 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28929 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28931 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28932 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28933 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28934 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28935 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28936 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28938 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28939 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28940 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28942 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28943 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28945 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28946 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28947 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28949 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28950 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28951 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28953 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28954 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28956 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28957 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28958 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28959 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28961 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
28962 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
28963 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
28964 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
28966 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28967 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28968 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28969 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28970 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28971 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28973 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28974 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28975 does require careful arrangement.
28976 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28977 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28978 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28979 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28980 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28982 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28983 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28985 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28986 "MTA-STS", described below.
28988 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28989 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28990 connections to you.
28991 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28992 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28993 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28994 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28995 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28996 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28998 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28999 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29000 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29001 random serial numbers.
29002 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29003 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29004 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29005 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29007 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29008 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29010 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29013 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29014 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29019 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29021 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29024 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29027 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29028 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29031 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29033 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29034 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29035 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29036 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29038 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29039 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29041 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29042 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29043 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29046 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29047 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29051 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29052 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29053 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29054 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29055 control the OCSP request.
29057 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29058 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29061 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29062 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29063 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29064 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29065 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29067 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29069 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29070 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29071 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29072 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29074 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29075 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29076 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29077 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29078 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29079 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29080 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29082 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29086 tls_try_verify_hosts
29087 tls_verify_certificates
29089 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29092 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29093 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29095 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29096 set to "never" and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29098 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29100 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29101 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29102 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29103 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29105 .cindex DANE reporting
29106 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29107 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29108 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29109 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29110 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29111 Section 4.3 of that document.
29113 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29115 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29116 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29117 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29118 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29119 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29120 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29121 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29122 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29125 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29126 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29127 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29129 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29130 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29131 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29132 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29133 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29134 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29135 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29142 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29143 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29144 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29145 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29146 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29147 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29148 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29149 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29150 one very small ACL:
29154 accept hosts = one.host.only
29156 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29157 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29159 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29160 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29161 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29162 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29163 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29164 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29165 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29166 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29169 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29170 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29171 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29174 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29175 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29176 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29177 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29178 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29179 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29180 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29181 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29182 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29183 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29184 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29185 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29186 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29187 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29188 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29189 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29190 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29191 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29192 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29193 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29196 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29197 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29198 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29199 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29200 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29201 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29202 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29203 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29204 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29205 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29206 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29207 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29208 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29209 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29210 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29211 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29212 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29213 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29214 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29215 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29218 For example, if you set
29220 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29222 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29223 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29224 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29225 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29226 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29227 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29228 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29231 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29232 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29233 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29234 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29235 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29236 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29237 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29238 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29239 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29240 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29241 in any of these ACLs.
29243 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29244 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29245 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29246 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29247 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29248 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29249 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29250 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29252 control = suppress_local_fixups
29254 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29255 run, it is too late.
29257 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29258 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29260 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29261 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29262 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29265 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29266 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29267 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29268 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29269 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29270 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29271 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29272 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29273 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29276 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29277 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29278 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29279 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29280 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29281 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29282 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29283 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29284 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29286 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29287 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29288 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29290 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29291 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29292 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29293 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29297 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29298 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29299 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29300 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29301 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29302 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29303 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29304 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29305 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29306 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29308 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29309 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29310 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29311 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29312 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29313 associated with the DATA command.
29315 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29316 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29317 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29318 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29319 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29320 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29321 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29322 the data specified is received.
29324 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29325 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29326 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29327 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29328 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29331 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29332 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29333 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29334 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29336 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29337 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29338 enabled (which is the default).
29340 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29341 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29342 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29344 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29346 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29349 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29350 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29351 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29353 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29356 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29357 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29358 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29359 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29360 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29361 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29362 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29365 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29366 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29367 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29368 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29369 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29370 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29371 for some or all recipients.
29373 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29374 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29375 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29376 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29377 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29379 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29380 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29381 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29383 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29384 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29386 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29387 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29388 the feature was not requested by the client.
29390 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29391 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29392 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29393 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29394 does not in fact control any access.
29395 For this reason, it may only accept
29396 or warn as its final result.
29398 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29399 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29400 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29401 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29403 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29404 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29406 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29407 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29410 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29411 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29412 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29413 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29414 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29417 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29418 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29419 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29420 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29421 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29422 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29423 situation even worse.
29425 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29426 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29427 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29430 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29431 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29432 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29433 connection. The possible values are:
29435 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29436 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29437 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29438 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29439 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29440 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29441 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29442 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29443 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29444 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29446 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29447 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29448 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29449 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29450 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29454 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29455 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29456 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29457 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29459 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29460 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29462 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29463 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29464 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29465 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29466 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29468 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29469 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29470 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29473 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29474 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29475 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29476 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29477 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29478 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29480 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29481 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29482 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29484 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29485 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29486 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29487 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29489 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29490 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29491 matches the string.
29493 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29494 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29495 want to have something like
29497 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29499 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29500 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29506 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29507 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29508 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29509 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29510 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29511 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29512 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29513 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29514 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29516 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29517 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29518 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29521 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29522 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29523 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29524 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29526 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29527 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29528 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29529 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29530 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29531 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29532 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29534 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29535 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29538 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29539 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29540 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29544 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29545 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29546 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29547 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29548 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29549 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29551 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29552 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29553 used to accept or reject anything.
29555 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29556 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29557 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29558 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29560 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29561 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29562 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29563 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29564 configuration file.
29569 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29570 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29572 .vindex &$local_part$&
29573 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29574 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29575 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29576 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29577 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29578 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29579 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29580 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29581 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29583 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29584 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29585 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29588 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29589 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29590 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29591 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29592 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29595 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29596 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29597 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29598 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29599 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29600 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29601 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29602 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29608 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29609 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29610 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29611 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29612 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29613 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29614 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29615 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29616 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29617 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29618 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29619 unencrypted connections.
29622 accept encrypted = *
29623 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29625 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29627 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29628 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29629 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29630 option to do this.)
29634 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29635 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29636 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29637 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29638 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29639 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29640 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29642 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29643 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29644 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29647 deny dnslists = list1.example
29648 dnslists = list2.example
29650 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29651 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29652 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29653 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29654 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29657 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29658 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29661 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29662 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29663 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29664 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29665 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29666 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29667 check a RCPT command:
29669 accept domains = +local_domains
29673 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29674 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29675 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29676 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29679 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29680 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29681 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29684 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29685 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29686 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29687 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29688 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29689 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29691 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29692 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29694 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29695 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29696 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29698 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29699 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29700 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29705 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29706 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29707 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29708 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29709 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29710 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29711 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29715 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29716 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29717 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29720 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29722 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29726 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29727 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29728 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29729 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29730 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29731 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29732 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29733 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29734 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29736 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29737 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29738 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29742 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29743 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29744 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29746 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29747 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29749 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29750 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29753 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29754 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29755 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29756 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29758 require message = Sender did not verify
29761 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29762 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29763 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29764 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29767 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29768 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29769 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29770 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29771 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29772 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29773 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29775 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29776 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29777 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29778 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29779 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29781 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29782 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29783 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29784 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29785 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29786 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29790 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29791 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29792 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29793 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29795 warn !verify = sender
29796 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29800 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29802 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29803 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29804 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29805 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29806 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29810 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29811 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29812 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29813 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29814 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29815 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29816 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29817 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29818 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29819 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29821 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29822 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29823 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29824 on the same SMTP connection.
29826 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29827 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29828 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29831 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29832 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29833 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29835 accept hosts = whatever
29836 set acl_m4 = some value
29837 accept authenticated = *
29838 set acl_c_auth = yes
29840 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29841 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29842 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29844 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29845 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29846 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29847 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29848 error is generated.
29850 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29851 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29854 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29855 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29856 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29857 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29859 deny domains = *.dom.example
29860 !verify = recipient
29862 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29863 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29864 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29865 two statements are equivalent:
29867 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29868 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29870 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29871 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29873 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29874 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29875 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29877 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29878 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29879 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29880 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29882 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29883 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29884 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29885 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29886 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29887 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29888 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29890 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29891 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29892 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29893 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29894 message is handled.
29896 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29897 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29898 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29899 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29901 require message = Can't verify sender
29903 message = Can't verify recipient
29905 message = This message cannot be used
29907 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29908 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29909 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29910 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29911 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29912 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29914 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29915 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29916 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29917 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29920 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29921 message = Invalid sender from client host
29923 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29924 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29928 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29929 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29930 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29933 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29934 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29935 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29936 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29938 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29939 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29940 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29941 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29942 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29943 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29944 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29945 write rather ugly lines like this:
29947 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29949 Instead, all you need is
29951 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29954 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29955 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29956 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29957 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29958 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29959 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29960 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29961 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29963 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29964 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29965 in several different ways. For example:
29967 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29968 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29969 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29973 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29975 accept ...some conditions
29976 control = queue_only
29978 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29979 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29982 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29984 accept ...some conditions...
29985 control = queue_only
29986 ...some more conditions...
29988 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29989 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29990 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29994 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29995 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29998 warn ...some conditions...
30002 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30003 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30007 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30008 &%require%& verb. For example:
30010 require control = no_multiline_responses
30014 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30015 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30017 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30018 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30019 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30020 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30021 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30022 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30024 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30027 deny ...some conditions...
30030 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30031 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
30034 ...some conditions...
30036 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30037 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30039 warn ...some conditions...
30045 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30046 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30047 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30048 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30049 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30050 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30051 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30055 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30056 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30057 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30058 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30059 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30060 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30061 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30064 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30065 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30066 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30067 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30069 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30070 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30072 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30075 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30076 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30078 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30079 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30080 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30083 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30084 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30085 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30086 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30087 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30088 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30091 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30092 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30093 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30096 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30097 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30098 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30099 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30100 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30101 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30103 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30104 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30105 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30106 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30107 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30108 logging rejections.
30111 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30112 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30113 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30114 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30115 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30116 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30117 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30118 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30120 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30121 &` log_reject_target =`&
30123 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30124 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30128 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30129 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30130 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30131 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30132 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30133 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30134 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30137 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30138 &` control = freeze`&
30139 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30141 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30142 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30143 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30146 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30147 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30151 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30152 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30153 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30154 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30155 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30156 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30157 &%accept%& for details.)
30159 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30160 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30161 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30162 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30163 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30165 require message = Host not recognized
30168 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30171 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30172 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30173 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30174 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30175 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30176 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30177 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30178 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30179 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30182 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30183 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30184 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30186 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30187 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30189 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30190 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30191 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30194 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30195 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30197 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30198 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30199 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30202 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30203 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30204 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30206 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30207 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30208 However, the original message is available in the variable
30209 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30210 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30211 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30212 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30214 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30215 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30216 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30217 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30218 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30219 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30223 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30224 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30225 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30226 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30228 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30230 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30231 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30232 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30233 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30236 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30237 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30238 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30239 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30242 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30243 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30244 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30245 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30248 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30249 .cindex "UDP communications"
30250 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30251 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30252 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30253 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30254 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30255 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30256 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30259 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30260 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30267 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30268 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30269 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30272 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30273 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30274 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30275 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30276 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30277 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30278 not work without it. For example:
30280 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30281 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30283 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30284 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30285 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30286 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30287 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30290 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30291 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30292 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30293 .cindex "case of local parts"
30294 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30295 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30296 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30297 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30298 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30299 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30302 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30303 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30304 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30305 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30306 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30308 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30309 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30312 warn control = caseful_local_part
30313 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30315 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30317 control = caselower_local_part
30319 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30320 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30323 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30324 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30325 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30326 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30328 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30329 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30330 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30331 is used for all recipients of the message,
30332 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30333 and data is copied from one to the other.
30335 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30336 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30337 If a recipient-verify callout
30339 connection is subsequently
30340 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30341 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30342 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30344 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30345 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30346 Note also that headers cannot be
30347 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30348 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30349 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30350 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30351 this will affect the timestamp.
30353 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30354 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30355 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30356 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30359 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30360 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30361 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30362 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30366 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30367 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30368 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30369 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30370 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30372 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30374 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30375 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30376 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30377 and does not queue the message.
30378 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30380 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30382 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30385 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30386 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30387 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30388 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30389 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30390 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30391 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30392 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30393 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30395 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30396 with the &'kill'& option.
30397 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30401 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30402 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30403 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30404 control = debug/kill
30408 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30409 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30410 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30411 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30412 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30415 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30416 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30417 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30418 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30419 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30420 strings or to numeric value.
30421 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30422 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30423 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30425 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30426 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30427 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30428 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30429 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30432 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30433 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30434 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30435 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30436 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30437 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30438 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30439 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30441 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30442 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30443 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30444 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30445 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30446 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30450 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30451 .cindex "fake defer"
30452 .cindex "defer, fake"
30453 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30454 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30455 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30456 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30457 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30459 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30460 .cindex "fake rejection"
30461 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30462 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30463 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30464 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30465 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30466 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30467 the same SMTP connection.
30469 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30470 message is supplied, the following is used:
30472 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30473 550-kept for evaluation.
30474 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30475 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30477 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30479 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30480 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30481 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30482 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30483 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30484 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30487 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30488 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30489 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30490 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30492 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30493 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30494 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30495 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30496 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30497 disables such output flushing.
30499 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30500 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30501 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30502 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30503 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30504 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30506 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30507 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30508 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30509 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30510 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30511 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30512 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30513 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30514 to be useful in production.
30516 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30517 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30518 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30519 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30520 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30522 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30523 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30524 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30525 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30526 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30527 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30530 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30531 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30532 verification failed"&) is sent.
30534 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30538 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30539 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30541 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30542 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30543 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30544 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30545 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30546 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30547 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30549 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30550 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30551 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30552 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30553 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30554 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30555 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30556 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30557 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30558 same SMTP connection.
30560 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30561 .cindex "message" "submission"
30562 .cindex "submission mode"
30563 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30564 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30565 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30566 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30567 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30568 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30569 late (the message has already been created).
30571 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30572 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30573 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30574 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30575 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30577 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30578 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30579 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30580 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30581 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30584 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30585 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30587 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30589 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30592 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30593 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30594 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30595 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30598 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30599 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30601 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30602 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30604 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30608 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30609 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30612 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30614 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30615 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30617 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30619 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30624 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30625 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30626 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30627 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30628 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30629 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30631 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30632 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30633 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30635 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30636 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30637 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30638 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30639 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30642 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30643 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30645 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30646 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30647 contains one or more newlines that
30648 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30649 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30650 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30652 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30653 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30654 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30655 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30656 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30657 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30658 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30659 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30660 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30661 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30662 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30664 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30665 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30667 until they are added to the
30668 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30669 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30670 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30671 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30672 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30673 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30674 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30676 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30678 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30679 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30681 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30682 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30684 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30685 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30687 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30688 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30689 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30690 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30693 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30694 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30695 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30696 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30697 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30698 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30699 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30702 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30703 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30704 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30705 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30706 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30708 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30709 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30710 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30711 to be a header name first.) For example:
30713 warn add_header = \
30714 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30716 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30717 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30718 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30719 up in reverse order.
30721 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30722 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30723 system filter or in a router or transport.
30727 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30728 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30729 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30730 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30731 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30732 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30734 warn message = Remove internal headers
30735 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30737 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30738 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30739 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30740 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30741 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30742 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30744 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30745 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30747 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30748 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30749 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30750 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30751 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30753 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30754 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30755 warn message = Remove internal headers
30756 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30758 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30759 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30760 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30761 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30762 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30763 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30764 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30765 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30766 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30767 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30768 would have been removed.
30770 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30771 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30772 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30773 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30774 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30775 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30776 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30777 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30778 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30780 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30781 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30783 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30784 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30786 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30787 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30789 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30790 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30791 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30792 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30795 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30796 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30797 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30802 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30803 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30804 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30805 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30806 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30807 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30809 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30810 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30811 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30812 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30813 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30814 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30815 The conditions are as follows:
30819 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30820 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30821 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30822 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30823 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30824 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30825 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30826 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30827 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30828 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30829 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30830 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30832 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30833 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30834 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30835 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30836 The name and values are expanded separately.
30837 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30838 will act as argument separators.
30840 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30841 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30842 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30843 conditions are tested.
30845 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30846 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30847 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30848 for different local users or different local domains.
30850 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30851 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30852 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30853 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30854 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30855 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30856 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30861 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30862 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30863 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30864 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30865 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30866 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30867 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30868 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30869 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30870 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30871 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30872 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30875 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30876 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30877 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30878 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30879 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30880 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30881 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30882 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30884 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30885 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30886 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30887 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30888 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30889 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30890 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30891 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30892 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30893 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30895 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30896 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30897 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30898 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30899 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30900 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30901 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30902 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30903 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30906 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30907 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30910 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30911 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30912 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30913 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30914 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30915 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30916 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30922 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30923 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30924 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30925 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30926 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30927 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30928 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30930 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30932 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30933 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30934 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30936 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30937 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30938 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30939 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30940 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30941 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30943 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30944 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30946 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30947 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30949 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30950 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30951 statement can then check the IP address.
30953 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30954 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30955 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30956 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30958 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30959 message = $host_data
30961 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30963 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30964 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30965 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30967 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30968 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30969 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30970 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30971 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30972 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30974 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30975 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30976 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30977 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30978 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30979 content-scanning extension
30980 and only after a DATA command.
30981 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30982 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30984 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30985 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30986 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30987 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30988 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30989 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30990 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30993 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30994 .cindex "rate limiting"
30995 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30996 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30998 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30999 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31000 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31001 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31002 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31003 recipient address against a list of recipients.
31005 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31006 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31007 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31008 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31009 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31010 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31011 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31013 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31014 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31015 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31016 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31017 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31018 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31019 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31020 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31021 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31022 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31023 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31024 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31025 influence the sender checking.
31027 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31028 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31030 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31031 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31032 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31033 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31034 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31035 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31039 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31040 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31042 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31043 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31044 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31045 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31046 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31047 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31049 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31050 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31051 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31052 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31053 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31054 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31055 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31056 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31057 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31058 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31060 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31061 .cindex "CSA verification"
31062 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31063 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31064 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31066 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31067 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31068 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31069 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31070 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31071 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31072 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31073 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31074 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31075 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31077 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31078 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31079 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31081 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31082 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31083 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31084 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31085 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31086 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31087 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31088 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31089 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31090 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31091 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31092 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31093 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31094 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31095 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31097 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31098 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31099 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31100 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31103 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31104 !verify = header_sender
31107 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31108 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31109 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31110 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31111 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31112 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31113 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31114 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31115 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31116 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31117 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31118 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31119 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31122 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31123 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31127 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31128 common as they used to be.
31130 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31131 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31132 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31133 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31134 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31135 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31136 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31137 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31138 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31139 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31140 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31141 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31142 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31144 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31145 option), this condition is always true.
31148 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31149 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31150 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31151 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31152 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31153 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31154 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31155 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31156 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31159 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31160 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31163 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31164 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31167 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31168 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31169 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31170 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31171 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31172 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31173 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31174 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31175 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31176 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31177 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31178 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31179 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31180 value for the child address.
31182 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31183 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31184 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31185 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31186 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31187 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31188 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31189 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31190 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31191 original IP address.
31193 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31194 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31196 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31197 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31199 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31200 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31201 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31202 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31203 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31204 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31205 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31206 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31207 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31209 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31210 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31211 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31212 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31213 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31214 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31215 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31217 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31218 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31219 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31221 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31222 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31223 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31224 verified as a sender.
31226 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31227 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31228 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31230 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31236 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31237 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31238 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31239 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31240 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31241 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31242 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31243 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31244 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31245 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31247 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31248 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31250 the following records are looked up:
31252 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31253 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31255 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31256 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31257 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31258 use two separate conditions:
31260 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31261 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31263 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31264 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31265 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31268 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31269 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31270 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31271 following special items in the list:
31273 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31274 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31275 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31277 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31278 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31279 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31280 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31282 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31284 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31285 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31287 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31288 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31289 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31291 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31293 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31294 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31295 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31296 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31297 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31298 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31300 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31301 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31302 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31306 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31307 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31308 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31309 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31310 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31312 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31314 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31315 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31316 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31317 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31322 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31323 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31324 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31325 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31326 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31327 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31328 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31330 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31331 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31333 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31334 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31335 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31336 up by this example is
31338 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31340 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31341 addresses. For example:
31343 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31344 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31346 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31347 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31352 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31353 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31354 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31355 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31356 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31357 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31358 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31359 either to double the separators like this:
31361 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31363 or to change the separator character, like this:
31365 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31367 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31368 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31369 occurs. Consider this condition:
31371 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31373 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31375 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31376 a.domain.black.list.tld
31378 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31379 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31380 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31381 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31382 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31383 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31384 error for a previous item.
31386 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31387 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31389 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31390 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31392 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31393 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31395 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31396 $sender_address_domain \
31397 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31399 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31400 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31401 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31403 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31404 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31405 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31406 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31408 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31410 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31411 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31413 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31414 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31419 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31420 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31421 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31422 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31423 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31424 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31428 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31430 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31431 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31432 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31434 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31435 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31436 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31439 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31440 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31441 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31442 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31443 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31444 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31445 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31446 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31447 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31448 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31449 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31450 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31451 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31452 cases, for example:
31454 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31456 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31457 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31458 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31459 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31461 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31463 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31464 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31466 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31467 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31468 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31469 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31470 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31473 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31474 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31475 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31477 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31478 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31480 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31485 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31486 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31487 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31488 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31491 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31493 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31494 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31495 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31496 describes how multiple records are handled.
31498 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31499 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31500 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31502 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31504 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31505 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31506 first. For example:
31508 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31509 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31512 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31513 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31514 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31515 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31516 tested. For example:
31518 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31520 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31521 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31522 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31524 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31526 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31531 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31532 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31535 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31537 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31538 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31540 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31542 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31543 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31544 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31545 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31547 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31548 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31550 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31551 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31553 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31554 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31556 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31557 Consider this example:
31559 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31561 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31564 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31566 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31568 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31569 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31570 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31572 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31577 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31578 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31579 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31580 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31581 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31582 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31584 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31586 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31587 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31588 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31589 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31590 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31591 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31594 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31595 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31596 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31598 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31599 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31602 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31604 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31605 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31607 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31609 for the condition to be true.
31612 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31613 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31615 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31616 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31618 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31620 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31621 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31623 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31624 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31626 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31628 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31629 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31631 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31633 for the condition to be false.
31635 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31636 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31641 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31642 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31643 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31644 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31645 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31646 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31647 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31648 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31649 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31652 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31653 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31654 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31655 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31656 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31657 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31658 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31661 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31662 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31664 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31665 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31667 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31668 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31669 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31670 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31671 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31672 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31674 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31675 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31676 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31679 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31680 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31681 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31682 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31684 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31685 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31686 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31690 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31691 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31692 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31693 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31694 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31695 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31697 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31698 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31700 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31701 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31702 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31704 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31706 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31707 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31709 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31710 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31712 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31713 dnslists = some.list.example
31716 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31717 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31718 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31720 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31723 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31724 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31725 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31726 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31727 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31728 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31729 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31730 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31731 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31732 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31734 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31736 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31737 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31739 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31740 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31741 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31744 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31745 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31746 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31747 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31748 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31749 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31750 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31751 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31752 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31754 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31755 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31756 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31757 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31759 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31760 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31761 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31762 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31763 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31764 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31765 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31766 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31767 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31768 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31770 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31771 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31772 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31775 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31776 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31777 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31778 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31779 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31780 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31782 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31783 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31784 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31785 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31786 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31787 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31788 the &%count=%& option.
31791 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31792 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31793 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31794 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31795 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31797 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31798 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31799 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31800 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31802 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31803 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31804 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31805 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31806 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31807 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31808 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31810 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31811 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31812 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31813 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31814 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31815 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31816 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31818 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31819 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31820 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31821 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31824 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31825 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31826 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31827 multiple different commands.
31829 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31830 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31831 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31832 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31833 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31835 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31838 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31839 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31840 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31841 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31842 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31844 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31845 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31847 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31848 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31849 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31850 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31854 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31855 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31856 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31859 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31860 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31861 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31864 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31865 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31866 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31867 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31868 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31869 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31872 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31873 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31874 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31875 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31876 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31879 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31880 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31881 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31882 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31883 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31884 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31887 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31888 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31889 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31890 up to the given limit.
31891 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31892 consists of refusing the message, and
31893 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31894 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31895 likely not what is wanted.
31897 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31898 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31899 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31900 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31901 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31902 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31903 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31904 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31906 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31910 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31911 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31912 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31913 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31914 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31915 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31916 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31917 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31918 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31920 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31921 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31922 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31923 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31924 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31925 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31927 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31928 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31931 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31932 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31933 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31934 required increases with larger limits.
31936 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31937 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31938 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31939 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31940 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31941 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31942 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31943 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31944 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31948 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31949 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31950 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31951 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31952 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31953 message. For example:
31955 # Log all senders' rates
31956 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31957 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31959 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31960 # at the decimal point.
31961 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31962 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31963 $sender_rate_limit }s
31965 # Keep authenticated users under control
31966 deny authenticated = *
31967 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31969 # System-wide rate limit
31970 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31971 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31973 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31974 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31975 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31976 messages per $sender_rate_period
31977 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31978 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31979 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31981 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31982 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31983 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31984 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31985 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31986 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31987 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31991 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31992 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31993 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31994 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31995 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31996 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31997 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31998 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31999 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32001 verify = sender/callout
32002 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32004 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32005 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32006 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32007 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32008 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32009 The available options are as follows:
32012 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32013 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32014 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32016 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32017 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32018 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32019 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32021 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32022 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32024 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32025 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32026 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32027 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32030 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32031 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32032 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32033 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32034 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32035 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32038 warn !verify = sender
32039 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32041 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32042 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32043 verification failure.
32045 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32046 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32049 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32050 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32052 &%route%&: Routing failed.
32054 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32055 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32056 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32058 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32060 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32063 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32064 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32066 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32067 address verification to:
32070 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32076 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32077 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32078 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32079 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32080 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32081 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32082 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32083 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32084 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32085 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32086 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32087 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32090 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32091 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32092 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32093 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32094 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32095 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32097 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32098 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32099 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32100 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32101 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32103 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32104 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32105 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32106 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32107 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32108 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32109 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32110 supplies a host list.
32111 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32113 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32114 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32115 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32116 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32117 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32118 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32119 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32121 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32122 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32123 following SMTP commands are sent:
32125 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32127 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32130 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32133 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32136 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32137 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32138 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32139 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32140 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32141 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32143 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32144 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32145 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32146 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32147 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32149 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32150 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32151 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32152 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32153 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32158 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32159 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32160 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32161 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32163 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32165 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32166 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32167 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32171 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32172 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32173 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32176 verify = sender/callout=5s
32178 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32179 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32180 the &%connect%& parameter.
32183 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32184 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32185 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32186 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32188 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32190 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32192 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32193 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32194 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32195 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32196 updated in this circumstance.
32198 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32199 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32200 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32201 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32202 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32203 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32206 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32207 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32208 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32209 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32210 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32211 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32212 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32213 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32214 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32215 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32217 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32219 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32222 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32223 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32224 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32227 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32229 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32230 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32231 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32232 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32233 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32236 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32237 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32238 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32239 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32241 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32242 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32243 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32244 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32245 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32246 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32247 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32248 made, until the cache record expires.
32250 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32251 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32252 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32255 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32257 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32258 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32260 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32262 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32263 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32264 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32265 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32269 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32270 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32271 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32272 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32273 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32275 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32277 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32278 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32279 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32280 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32281 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32283 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32284 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32285 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32287 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32289 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32290 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32291 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32292 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32293 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32295 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32296 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32298 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32300 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32301 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32302 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32303 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32304 usefulness of callout caching.
32307 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32309 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32311 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32312 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32313 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32314 when that is used for the connections.
32315 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32316 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32317 if the use_sender option is used,
32318 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32319 and if no other callouts intervene.
32322 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32323 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32324 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32325 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32326 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32327 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32328 these circumstances.
32330 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32331 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32332 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32333 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32334 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32335 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32336 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32338 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32339 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32340 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32341 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32346 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32347 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32348 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32349 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32350 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32351 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32352 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32353 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32354 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32355 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32357 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32358 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32361 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32362 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32363 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32365 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32366 commands up to and including
32370 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32371 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32372 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32373 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32374 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32375 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32376 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32378 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32379 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32380 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32381 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32382 will eventually be noticed.
32384 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32385 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32386 behaviour will be the same.
32390 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32391 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32392 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32393 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32394 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32395 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32398 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32400 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32401 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32402 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32403 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32404 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32405 550 Sender verification failed
32407 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32408 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32409 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32410 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32413 verify = sender/no_details
32416 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32417 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32418 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32419 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32420 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32421 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32422 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32425 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32426 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32427 verification also fails.
32429 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32430 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32433 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32434 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32435 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32438 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32440 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32441 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32442 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32443 verification to succeed.
32445 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32446 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32447 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32448 option. For example:
32450 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32452 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32453 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32455 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32456 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32457 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32458 address and a report is output for each of them.
32462 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32463 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32464 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32465 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32466 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32467 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32468 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32472 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32473 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32474 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32475 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32476 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32477 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32479 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32480 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32481 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32482 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32485 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32487 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32489 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32490 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32492 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32493 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32496 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32497 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32499 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32501 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32502 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32503 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32504 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32507 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32509 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32510 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32511 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32513 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32514 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32515 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32516 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32517 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32518 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32519 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32520 of legitimate HELO domains.
32522 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32523 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32524 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32525 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32528 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32530 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32531 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32532 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32537 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32538 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32539 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32540 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32541 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32542 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32543 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32544 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32546 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32547 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32548 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32549 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32550 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32551 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32552 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32553 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32555 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32556 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32559 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32560 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32563 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32564 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32567 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32568 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32570 recipients = +batv_senders
32572 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32573 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32575 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32576 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32577 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32579 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32580 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32581 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32582 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32583 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32585 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32586 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32587 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32588 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32589 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32590 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32591 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32593 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32594 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32595 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32596 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32600 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32602 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32603 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32604 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32607 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32610 external_smtp_batv:
32612 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32613 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32614 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32615 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32618 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32622 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32623 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32624 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32625 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32626 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32627 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32628 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32629 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32630 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32631 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32633 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32634 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32635 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32636 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32637 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32638 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32640 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32642 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32643 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32644 system to arbitrary domains.
32647 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32648 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32649 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32650 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32653 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32654 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32655 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32657 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32658 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32660 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32661 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32665 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32667 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32668 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32669 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32671 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32675 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32676 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32678 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32679 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32680 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32681 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32682 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32683 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32684 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32688 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32689 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32690 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32691 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32692 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32700 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32701 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32702 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32703 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32704 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32705 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32708 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32709 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32710 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32711 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32712 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32714 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32715 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32716 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32719 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32720 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32722 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32723 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32724 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32726 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32727 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32729 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32732 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32735 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32736 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32737 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32738 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32739 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32740 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32742 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32743 temporarily created in a file called:
32745 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32747 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32748 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32749 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32750 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32751 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32753 control = no_mbox_unspool
32755 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32756 same directory by default.
32760 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32761 .cindex "virus scanning"
32762 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32763 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32764 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32765 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32766 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32767 in memory and thus are much faster.
32770 Since message data needs to have arrived,
32771 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32773 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32774 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32778 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32779 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32781 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32782 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32783 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32784 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32786 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32788 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32790 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32792 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32794 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32795 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32796 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32800 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32801 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32802 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32803 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32804 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32805 This scanner type takes one option,
32806 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32807 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32808 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32809 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32810 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32811 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32812 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32814 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32815 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32816 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32817 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32822 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32823 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32824 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32826 If you omit the argument, the default path
32827 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32829 If you use a remote host,
32830 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32831 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32832 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32834 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32840 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32841 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32842 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32844 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32845 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32846 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32847 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32848 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32851 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32856 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32857 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32858 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32859 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32860 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32862 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32863 a UNIX socket specification,
32864 a TCP socket specification,
32865 or a (global) option.
32867 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32868 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32869 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32870 and the second a port number,
32871 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32872 These per-server options are supported:
32874 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32877 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32878 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32880 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32884 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32885 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32886 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32887 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32888 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32890 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32892 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32893 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32894 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32895 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32897 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32898 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32899 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32900 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32901 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32902 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32903 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32904 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32905 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32907 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32908 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32909 (Connection refused)
32912 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32913 contributing the code for this scanner.
32916 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32917 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32918 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32919 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32922 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32923 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32926 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32927 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32928 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32929 the &"trigger"& expression.
32932 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32933 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32934 &"name"& expression.
32937 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32939 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32941 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32942 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32943 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32944 configuration setting:
32946 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32947 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32948 found in file:'(.+)'
32951 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32952 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32954 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32955 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32956 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32957 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32960 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32961 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32963 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32964 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32967 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32968 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32969 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32973 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32975 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32977 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32978 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32979 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32980 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32983 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32985 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32988 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32989 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32990 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32992 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32994 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32995 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32997 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32998 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32999 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33000 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33001 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33004 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33006 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33009 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33010 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33011 though some documentation was available in English.
33012 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33013 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33014 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33016 The only option for this scanner type is
33017 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33018 provided that mksd has
33019 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33021 av_scanner = mksd:2
33023 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33026 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33027 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33028 running on the local machine.
33029 There are four options:
33030 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33031 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33032 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33033 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33034 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33037 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33039 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33040 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33041 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33042 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33043 specify an empty element to get this.
33046 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33047 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33048 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33049 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33050 client communication. For example:
33052 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33054 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33058 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33059 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33062 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33063 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33064 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33065 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33066 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33067 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33070 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33071 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33072 The first element can then be one of
33075 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33076 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33079 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33080 the condition fails immediately.
33082 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33083 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33084 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33085 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33086 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33089 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33090 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33091 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33093 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33094 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33097 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33099 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33101 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33102 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33103 is set to record the actual address used.
33105 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33106 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33107 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33108 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33111 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33112 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33114 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33116 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33119 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33121 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33122 malware = */defer_ok
33124 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33125 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33127 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33129 in the main Exim configuration.
33131 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33132 set acl_m0 = sophie
33135 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33136 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33141 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33142 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33143 .cindex "spam scanning"
33144 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33146 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33147 score and a report for the message.
33148 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33150 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33151 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33152 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33154 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33156 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33158 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33159 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33162 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33163 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33164 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33165 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33166 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33167 configuration as follows (example):
33169 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33171 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33172 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33173 iptables firewall, consider setting
33174 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33175 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33176 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33177 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33181 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33183 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33185 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33188 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33189 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33190 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33192 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33194 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33195 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33196 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33197 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33199 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33200 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33203 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33204 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33205 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33208 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33209 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33210 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33211 take care to not double the separator.
33213 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33214 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33215 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33216 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33218 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33220 The supported options are:
33222 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33223 weight=<value> Selection bias
33224 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33225 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33226 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33227 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33230 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33231 higher values being tried first.
33232 The default priority is 1.
33234 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33235 Within a priority set
33236 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33237 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33239 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33240 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33241 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33242 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33244 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33245 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33247 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33248 The default value is two minutes.
33250 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33251 a failed connect is made.
33252 The default is to not retry.
33254 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33255 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33256 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33259 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33260 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33261 is set to record the actual address used.
33263 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33264 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33266 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33269 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33270 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33271 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33272 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33273 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33276 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33277 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33278 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33279 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33280 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33282 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33283 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33285 or the use of PRDR,
33286 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33287 are needed to use this feature.
33289 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33290 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33291 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33294 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33295 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33296 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33299 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33300 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33304 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33305 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33306 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33307 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33309 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33310 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33312 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33313 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33314 available for use at delivery time.
33317 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33318 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33319 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33321 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33322 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33323 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33324 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33325 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33327 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33328 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33329 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33330 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33331 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33332 spam bar is 50 characters.
33334 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33335 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33336 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33337 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33338 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33339 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33340 unencoded in headers.
33342 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33343 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33344 spam score versus threshold.
33345 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33349 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33350 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33351 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33353 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33354 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33355 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33356 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33357 spam condition, like this:
33359 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33360 spam = joe/defer_ok
33362 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33364 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33367 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33368 warn spam = nobody:true
33369 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33370 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33372 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33373 # is over threshold
33375 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33377 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33378 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33380 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33385 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33386 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33387 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33388 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33389 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33390 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33391 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33392 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33393 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33394 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33397 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33398 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33399 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33400 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33401 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33402 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33403 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33405 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33406 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33407 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33408 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33409 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33411 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33412 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33413 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33414 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33415 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33418 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33420 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33424 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33426 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33427 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33428 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33429 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33431 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33432 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33433 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33434 the full path and filename.
33436 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33437 filename, and the default path is then used.
33439 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33440 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33441 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33443 decode = $mime_filename
33445 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33446 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33447 automatically unlinked.
33449 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33450 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33451 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33452 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33453 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33455 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33456 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33457 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33459 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33460 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33461 available in the MIME ACL:
33464 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33465 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33466 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33467 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33468 contains the empty string.
33470 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33471 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33472 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33478 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33479 case-insensitively.
33481 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33482 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33483 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33484 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33485 only used for display purposes.
33487 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33488 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33489 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33491 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33492 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33493 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33495 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33496 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33497 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33498 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33499 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33501 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33502 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33503 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33504 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33506 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33507 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33508 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33509 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33513 application/octet-stream
33517 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33520 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33521 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33522 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33523 containing the decoded data.
33528 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33529 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33530 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33531 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33534 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33536 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33538 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33539 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33540 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33541 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33543 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33544 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33548 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33551 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33552 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33555 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33556 and the rest are attachments.
33559 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33562 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33563 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33564 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33566 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33567 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33568 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33569 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33571 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33572 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33573 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33574 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33575 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33577 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33578 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33579 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33580 decoding is fully recursive.
33582 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33583 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33584 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33585 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33586 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33587 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33588 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33593 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33594 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33595 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33596 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33597 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33599 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33600 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33601 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33602 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33603 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33605 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33606 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33607 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33608 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33609 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33610 32K characters are checked.
33612 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33613 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33614 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33615 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33616 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33618 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33619 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33621 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33622 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33623 matching regular expression.
33624 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33625 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33627 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33636 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33638 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33639 "Local scan function"
33640 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33641 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33642 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33643 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33644 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33646 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33647 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33648 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33649 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33650 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33652 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33653 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33654 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33655 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33657 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33658 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33659 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33660 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33662 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33663 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33664 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33665 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33666 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33667 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33668 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33669 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33670 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33674 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33675 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33676 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33677 function is before building Exim, by setting
33678 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33679 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33680 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33681 directory, so you might set
33683 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33684 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33686 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33687 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33688 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33689 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33690 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33691 _src/local_scan.c_.
33693 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33694 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33696 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33698 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33703 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33704 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33705 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33706 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33708 #include "local_scan.h"
33710 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33711 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33712 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33713 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33714 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33715 strings and pointers to character strings:
33717 #define CS (char *)
33718 #define CCS (const char *)
33719 #define CSS (char **)
33720 #define US (unsigned char *)
33721 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33722 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33724 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33726 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33728 The arguments are as follows:
33731 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33732 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33733 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33735 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33736 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33737 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33738 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33739 case this changes in some future version.
33741 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33742 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33745 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33748 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33749 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33750 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33751 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33752 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33753 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33755 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33756 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33757 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33759 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33760 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33761 queued without immediate delivery.
33763 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33764 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33765 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33766 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33767 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33770 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33771 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33772 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33775 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33776 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33777 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33778 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33779 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33780 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33781 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33783 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33784 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33785 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33788 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33789 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33790 &%-oe%& command line options.
33794 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33795 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33796 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33797 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33798 want to do this, you must have the line
33800 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33802 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33803 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33804 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33807 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33808 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33809 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33810 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33811 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33812 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33814 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33815 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33817 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33818 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33819 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33822 int local_scan_options_count =
33823 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33825 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33826 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33830 my_string = some string of text...
33832 The available types of option data are as follows:
33835 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33836 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33837 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33838 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33839 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33840 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33843 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33844 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33845 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33846 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33849 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33850 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33853 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33854 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33855 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33856 printed with the suffix K or M.
33858 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33859 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33860 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33861 always output in octal.
33863 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33864 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33865 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33867 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33868 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33869 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33872 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33873 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33877 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33878 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33879 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33880 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33881 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33882 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33883 C variables are as follows:
33886 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33887 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33888 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33890 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33891 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33892 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33894 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33895 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33896 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33897 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33900 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33901 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33902 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33905 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33906 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33910 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33911 selected, you should use code like this:
33913 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33914 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33916 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33917 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33918 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33920 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33921 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33924 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33925 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33927 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33928 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33930 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33931 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33932 &%-bh%& command line option.
33934 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33935 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33936 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33938 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33939 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33940 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33941 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33943 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33944 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33945 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33947 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33948 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33950 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33951 The number of accepted recipients.
33953 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33954 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33955 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33956 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33957 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33958 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33959 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33960 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33961 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33962 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33963 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33964 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33966 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33967 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33969 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33970 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33971 locally-submitted messages.
33973 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33974 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33975 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33977 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33978 The name of the sending host, if known.
33980 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33981 The port on the sending host.
33983 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33984 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33986 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33987 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33989 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33990 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33991 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33995 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33996 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33997 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33998 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34003 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34004 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34006 .vitem &*int&~type*&
34007 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34008 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34009 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34010 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34011 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34012 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34014 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
34015 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34018 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34019 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34020 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34025 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34026 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34029 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34030 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34032 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
34033 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34034 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34035 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34037 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34038 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34039 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34040 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34041 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34042 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34043 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34044 is NULL for all recipients.
34049 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34050 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34051 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34052 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34056 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34057 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34059 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34060 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34061 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34062 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34064 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34065 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34066 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34067 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34068 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34070 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34072 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34073 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34074 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34075 return value is as follows:
34080 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34086 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34092 The process timed out.
34096 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34099 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34100 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34101 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34102 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34103 forks a subprocess that is running
34105 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34107 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34108 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34109 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34110 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34112 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34113 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34114 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34115 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34118 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34119 *sender_authentication)*&
34120 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34123 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34125 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34128 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34129 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34130 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34131 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34132 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34134 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34135 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34138 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34139 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34140 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34141 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34142 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34143 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34144 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34145 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34147 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34148 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34149 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34150 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34151 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34152 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34154 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34155 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34156 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34157 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34159 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34160 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34161 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34162 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34163 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34164 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34165 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34166 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34167 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34168 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34170 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34171 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34173 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34174 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34177 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34178 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34179 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34180 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34181 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34184 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34185 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34186 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34187 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34188 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34189 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34191 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34193 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34194 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34195 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34196 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34197 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34200 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34201 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34202 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34203 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34204 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34205 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34206 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34207 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34209 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34210 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34211 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34213 &`OK `& match succeeded
34214 &`FAIL `& match failed
34215 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34217 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34218 inability to contact a database.
34220 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34222 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34223 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34224 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34226 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34228 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34229 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34230 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34232 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34234 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34237 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34239 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34240 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34241 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34242 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34243 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34244 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34247 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34249 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34250 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34251 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34252 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34253 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34254 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34257 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34258 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34259 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34260 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34262 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34263 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34264 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34265 value afterwards. For example:
34267 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34268 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34269 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34272 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34273 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34274 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34275 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34282 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34283 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34284 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34285 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34286 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34287 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34288 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34289 binary string is returned with an error message.
34291 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34292 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34293 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34295 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34296 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34297 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34298 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34299 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34301 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34302 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34303 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34305 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34306 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34307 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34308 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34312 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34313 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34317 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34318 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34320 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34321 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34322 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34323 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34324 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34325 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34328 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34329 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34332 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34333 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34334 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34335 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34337 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API.
34338 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent.
34339 A decision on the way forward has not yet been made.
34342 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34343 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34344 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34345 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34346 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34347 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34348 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34350 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34351 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34353 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34354 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34355 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34356 multiple output lines.
34358 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34361 guarantee a flush of
34363 pending output, and therefore does not test
34364 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34365 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34366 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34367 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34368 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34371 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34372 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34373 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34374 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34376 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34377 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34378 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34380 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34383 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34386 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34387 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34388 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34389 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34390 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34391 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34397 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34398 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34399 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34400 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34401 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34402 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34403 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34406 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34407 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34408 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34409 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34411 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34412 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34414 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34416 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34417 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34418 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34419 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34421 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34422 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34423 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34424 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34434 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34435 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34436 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34437 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34438 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34439 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34440 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34441 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34443 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34444 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34445 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34446 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34447 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34449 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34450 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34451 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34452 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34453 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34454 prevent it happening on retries.
34456 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34457 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34458 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34459 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34460 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34461 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34462 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34463 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34466 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34467 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34468 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34469 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34470 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34471 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34472 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34474 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34475 system_filter_user = exim
34477 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34478 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34479 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34480 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34481 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34482 by the &%reply%& command.
34485 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34486 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34487 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34488 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34490 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34491 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34495 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34496 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34497 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34498 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34499 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34500 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34503 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34504 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34505 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34506 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34507 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34508 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34509 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34511 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34512 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34513 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34514 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34515 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34517 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34518 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34519 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34520 to which users' filter files can refer.
34524 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34525 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34526 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34527 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34528 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34532 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34533 .cindex "freezing messages"
34534 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34535 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34536 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34537 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34538 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34539 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34540 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34541 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34542 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34543 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34545 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34547 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34549 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34550 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34551 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34552 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34553 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34556 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34557 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34558 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34559 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34561 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34562 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34563 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34564 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34565 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34566 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34567 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34568 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34569 message. For example:
34571 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34572 because it contains attachments that we are \
34573 not prepared to receive."
34576 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34577 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34578 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34579 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34580 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34581 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34584 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34585 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34587 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34588 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34589 generated by the filter.
34591 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34593 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34594 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34600 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34601 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34606 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34607 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34608 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34609 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34610 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34612 headers add <string>
34613 headers remove <string>
34615 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34616 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34617 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34618 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34619 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34621 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34622 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34623 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34626 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34627 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34630 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34631 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34632 space after input continuations is ignored.
34634 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34635 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34636 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34637 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34638 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34640 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34641 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34642 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34643 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34644 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34645 used for all recipients of the message.
34647 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34648 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34649 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34650 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34651 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34652 until the message is actually being written (see section
34653 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34655 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34656 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34657 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34658 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34659 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34660 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34661 modified more than once.
34663 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34664 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34667 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34668 headers remove "Subject"
34669 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34670 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34675 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34676 .cindex "envelope from"
34677 .cindex "envelope sender"
34678 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34680 errors_to <some address>
34682 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34683 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34684 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34687 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34689 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34690 address if its delivery failed.
34694 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34695 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34696 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34697 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34698 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34699 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34700 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34701 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34702 which implements such a filter:
34707 domains = +local_domains
34708 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34713 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34714 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34715 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34716 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34718 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34719 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34720 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34721 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34723 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34724 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34725 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34735 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34736 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34737 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34738 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34739 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34740 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34741 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34742 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34744 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34745 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34746 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34747 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34748 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34750 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34751 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34752 loopback interface specially in any way.
34754 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34755 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34760 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34761 .cindex "message" "submission"
34762 .cindex "submission mode"
34763 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34764 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34765 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34766 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34768 control = submission
34770 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34771 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34772 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34773 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34774 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34775 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34777 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34778 control = submission
34780 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34781 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34782 is used to separate options. For example:
34784 control = submission/sender_retain
34786 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34787 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34788 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34789 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34790 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34791 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34792 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34794 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34795 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34798 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34800 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34801 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34802 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34803 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34805 accept authenticated = *
34806 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34807 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34808 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34810 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34811 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34812 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34814 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34816 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34819 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34821 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34822 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34823 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34824 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34826 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34827 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34828 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34829 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34830 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34831 spoof another's address.
34833 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34834 .cindex "line endings"
34835 .cindex "carriage return"
34837 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34838 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34839 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34840 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34841 use CRLF or just CR.
34843 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34844 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34845 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34846 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34847 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34848 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34849 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34850 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34854 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34856 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34859 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34860 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34863 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34864 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34865 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34866 people trying to play silly games.
34868 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34869 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34877 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34878 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34879 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34880 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34881 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34882 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34883 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34884 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34886 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34887 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34888 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34889 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34890 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34892 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34893 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34894 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34895 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34896 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34897 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34898 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34899 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34904 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34905 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34906 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34907 .cindex "sender" "address"
34908 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34909 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34910 .cindex "envelope from"
34911 .cindex "envelope sender"
34912 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34913 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34914 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34915 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34917 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34918 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34920 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34921 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34922 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34923 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34924 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34925 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34926 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34927 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34928 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34930 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34931 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34932 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34933 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34934 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34935 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34936 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34938 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34939 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34940 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34942 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34943 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34944 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34945 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34949 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34950 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34951 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34952 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34953 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34954 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34955 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34956 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34959 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34960 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34963 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34964 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34968 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34969 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34971 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34972 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34973 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34975 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34978 For a locally-submitted message,
34979 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34980 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34981 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34982 included in log lines in this case.
34984 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34985 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34991 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34992 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34993 includes the header line:
34995 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34998 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34999 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35000 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35001 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35002 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35003 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35006 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35007 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35008 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35009 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35010 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35011 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35013 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35014 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35015 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35016 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35017 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35018 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35019 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35020 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35024 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35025 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35026 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35027 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35028 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35029 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35030 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35031 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35032 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35036 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35037 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35038 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
35039 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35040 .cindex "message" "submission"
35041 .cindex "submission mode"
35042 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35043 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35046 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35047 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35049 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35050 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35052 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35053 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35054 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35056 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35057 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35059 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35060 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35064 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35066 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35067 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35068 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35069 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35070 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35071 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35072 &%qualify_domain%&.
35074 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35075 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35076 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35077 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35080 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35081 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35082 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35083 .cindex "message" "submission"
35084 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35085 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35086 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35087 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35088 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35089 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35090 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35091 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35092 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35093 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35096 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35097 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35098 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35099 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35100 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35101 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35103 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35104 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35105 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35106 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35108 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35109 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35110 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35113 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35114 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35115 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35116 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35117 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35118 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35119 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35120 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35121 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35122 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35123 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35124 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35128 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35129 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35130 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35131 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35132 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35133 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35134 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35135 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35136 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35140 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35141 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35142 .cindex "message" "submission"
35143 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35144 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35145 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35146 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35147 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35150 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35151 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35152 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35153 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35154 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35155 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35156 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35157 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35158 line is added to the message.
35160 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35161 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35162 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35163 options true at the same time.
35165 .cindex "submission mode"
35166 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35167 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35168 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35169 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35171 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35172 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35173 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35174 created as follows:
35177 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35178 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35179 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35181 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35182 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35184 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35185 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35188 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35189 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35190 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35191 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35193 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35194 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35195 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35196 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35200 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35201 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35202 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35203 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35204 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35205 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35206 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35207 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35208 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35210 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35211 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35212 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35213 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35214 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35215 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35217 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35218 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35219 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35221 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35222 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35223 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35225 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35226 X-added-second: another added header line
35228 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35230 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35231 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35232 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35234 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35235 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35236 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35237 not part of the names. For example:
35239 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35242 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35243 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35244 Each item is separately expanded.
35245 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35246 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35247 will act as list separators.
35249 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35250 items are expanded at routing time,
35251 and then associated with all addresses that are
35252 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35253 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35254 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35256 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35257 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35258 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35259 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35261 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35262 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35263 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35266 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35267 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35268 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35269 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35270 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35271 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35272 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35274 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35275 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35276 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35277 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35279 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35280 the following consequences:
35283 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35284 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35285 to it, at all times.
35287 Header lines that are added by a router's
35288 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35289 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35291 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35292 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35294 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35295 a later router or by a transport.
35297 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35298 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35300 headers_remove = subject
35301 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35305 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35306 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35312 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35313 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35314 .cindex "constructed address"
35315 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35318 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35322 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35324 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35325 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35326 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35327 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35328 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35329 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35330 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35331 there is no password file entry.
35334 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35335 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35336 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35337 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35338 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35339 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35340 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35341 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35345 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35346 .cindex "case of local parts"
35347 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35348 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35349 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35350 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35351 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35352 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35353 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35356 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35357 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35358 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35359 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35360 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35364 domains = +local_domains
35365 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35366 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35369 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35370 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35371 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35372 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35373 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35377 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35378 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35379 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35380 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35381 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35382 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35383 empty components for compatibility.
35387 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35388 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35389 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35390 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35391 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35392 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35394 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35395 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35396 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35397 example, a header such as
35401 might get rewritten as
35403 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35405 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35406 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35409 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35410 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35411 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35412 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35413 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35414 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35415 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35422 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35423 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35424 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35425 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35426 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35427 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35428 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35431 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35433 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35435 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35438 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35441 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35443 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35446 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35449 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35450 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35453 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35454 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35455 used to contain the envelope information.
35459 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35460 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35461 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35462 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35463 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35466 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35467 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35468 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35469 processing is the same in both cases.
35471 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35472 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35473 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35474 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35475 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35476 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35477 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35478 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35481 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35482 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35483 required for the transaction.
35485 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35486 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35487 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35488 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35489 is called for verification.
35491 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35492 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35493 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35495 .cindex "carriage return"
35497 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35498 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35499 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35502 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35503 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35504 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35505 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35506 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35507 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35508 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35509 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35510 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35512 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35513 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35514 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35515 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35517 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35518 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35519 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35520 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35522 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35523 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35524 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35525 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35526 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35527 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35528 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35529 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35530 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35531 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35533 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35534 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35536 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35537 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35538 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35539 square bracket of the IP address.
35544 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35545 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35546 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35547 .cindex "host" "error"
35548 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35549 message errors, and recipient errors.
35552 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35553 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35554 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35557 Connection refused or timed out,
35559 Any error response code on connection,
35561 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35563 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35565 I/O errors at any time,
35567 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35568 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35571 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35572 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35573 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35574 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35575 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35576 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35577 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35578 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35580 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35581 .cindex "message" "error"
35582 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35583 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35584 message errors are:
35587 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35590 Timeout after MAIL,
35592 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35593 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35594 connection at any other time.
35597 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35598 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35599 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35600 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35601 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35602 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35603 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35604 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35605 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35606 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35608 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35609 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35610 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35613 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35614 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35615 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35616 recipient errors are:
35619 Any error response to RCPT,
35621 Timeout after RCPT.
35624 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35625 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35626 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35627 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35628 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35629 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35630 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35631 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35632 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35633 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35634 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35635 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35636 the retry clock is reset.
35638 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35639 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35640 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35641 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35642 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35643 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35644 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35645 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35646 recipient's retry time.
35649 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35650 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35651 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35652 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35653 until the next delivery attempt.
35655 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35656 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35657 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35658 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35659 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35662 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35663 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35664 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35665 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35666 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35667 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35668 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35670 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35671 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35672 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35673 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35674 then to be treated as a host error.
35676 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35677 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35678 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35679 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35680 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35685 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35686 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35687 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35690 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35691 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35692 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35694 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35696 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35697 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35698 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35699 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35700 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35701 stream and exits with an error code.
35703 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35704 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35705 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35706 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35708 .cindex "carriage return"
35710 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35711 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35712 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35714 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35715 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35716 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35718 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35719 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35720 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35721 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35722 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35723 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35724 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35725 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35727 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35728 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35729 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35730 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35731 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35732 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35733 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35734 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35735 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35737 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35738 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35739 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35741 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35742 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35743 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35744 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35745 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35747 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35748 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35749 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35750 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35751 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35752 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35753 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35755 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35756 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35757 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35758 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35759 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35761 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35762 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35763 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35764 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35765 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35766 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35767 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35768 a delivery process.
35770 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35771 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35772 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35773 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35774 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35776 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35777 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35778 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35779 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35781 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35782 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35783 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35787 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35788 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35789 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35790 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35791 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35792 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35793 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35794 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35797 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35798 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35799 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35800 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35801 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35802 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35803 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35804 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35805 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35806 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35807 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35811 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35812 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35813 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35814 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35815 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35816 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35817 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35818 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35820 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35821 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35822 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35823 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35824 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35827 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35828 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35829 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35831 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35832 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35833 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35834 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35835 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35840 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35841 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35842 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35843 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35845 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35846 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35847 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35848 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35849 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35850 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35851 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35852 SMTP response codes.
35854 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35855 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35856 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35857 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35858 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35859 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35860 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35861 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35866 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35867 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35868 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35869 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35870 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35871 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35872 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35874 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35875 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35876 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35877 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35878 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35879 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35880 argument. For example,
35888 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35889 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35890 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35891 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35892 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35894 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35895 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35896 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35897 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35898 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35899 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35900 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35901 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35903 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35904 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35905 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35906 whatever the form of its argument. For
35909 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35910 $sender_host_address
35912 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35913 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35914 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35915 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35916 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35917 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35918 for it to change them before running the command.
35922 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35923 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35924 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35925 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35926 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35927 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35928 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35929 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35930 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35931 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35932 runs for RCPT commands:
35936 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35940 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35941 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35942 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35943 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35944 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35945 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35946 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35947 envelope along with the message.
35949 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35950 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35951 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35952 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35953 can be used to specify it.
35955 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35956 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35957 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35958 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35959 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35962 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35963 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35964 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35969 driver = manualroute
35970 transport = smtp_appendfile
35971 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35975 driver = appendfile
35976 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35981 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35982 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35983 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35987 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35988 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35989 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35990 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35991 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35992 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35993 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35994 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35995 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35996 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35998 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35999 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36001 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36002 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36003 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36004 make some use of automatically, for example:
36006 554 Unexpected end of file
36007 Transaction started in line 10
36008 Error detected in line 14
36010 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36013 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36014 The error message was:
36016 501 '>' missing at end of address
36018 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36019 The error was detected in line 12.
36020 The SMTP command at fault was:
36022 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36024 1 previous message was successfully processed.
36025 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36027 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36028 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36030 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36031 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36035 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36036 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36038 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36039 "Customizing messages"
36040 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36041 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36042 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36043 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36044 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36046 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36047 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36048 option. Exim also adds the line
36050 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36052 to all warning and bounce messages,
36055 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36056 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36057 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36058 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36059 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36060 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36061 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36063 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36064 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36065 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36066 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36067 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36070 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36071 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36072 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36073 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36074 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36075 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36076 option, rounded to a whole number.
36078 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36081 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36082 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36084 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36085 failing addresses with their error messages.
36087 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36088 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36090 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36091 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36094 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36095 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36096 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36098 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36099 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36100 {: returning message to sender}}
36102 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36104 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36105 {that you sent }{sent by
36109 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36110 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36112 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36114 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36117 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36119 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36122 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36123 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36124 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36125 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36126 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36130 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36131 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36133 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36134 the delayed addresses.
36136 The third item then ends the message.
36139 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36140 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36142 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36143 $warn_message_delay
36145 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36147 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36148 {that you sent }{sent by
36152 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36153 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36155 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36156 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36157 The date of the message is: $h_date
36159 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36161 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36162 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36163 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36164 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36165 the message will be returned to you.
36167 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36168 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36169 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36170 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36171 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36172 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36173 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36174 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36183 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36184 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36185 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36189 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36190 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36191 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36192 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36193 routing explicitly:
36195 send_to_smart_host:
36196 driver = manualroute
36197 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36198 transport = remote_smtp
36200 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36201 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36202 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36203 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36204 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36209 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36210 .cindex "mailing lists"
36211 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36212 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36213 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36215 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36216 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36217 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36218 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36222 domains = lists.example
36223 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36226 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36229 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36230 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36231 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36232 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36234 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36235 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36238 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36239 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36240 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36241 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36242 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36244 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36245 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36246 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36247 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36248 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36249 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36250 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36251 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36252 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36256 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36257 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36258 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36259 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36260 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36261 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36262 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36264 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36265 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36266 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36267 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36268 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36272 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36273 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36274 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36275 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36276 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36277 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36278 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36279 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36280 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36281 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36283 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36284 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36285 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36286 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36287 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36288 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36289 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36290 pre-existing messages.
36292 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36293 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36294 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36295 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36296 one level of expansion anyway.
36300 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36301 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36302 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36303 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36304 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36305 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36307 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36308 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36312 domains = lists.example
36313 local_part_suffix = -request
36314 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36319 domains = lists.example
36320 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36321 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36322 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36325 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36330 domains = lists.example
36332 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36334 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36335 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36336 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36339 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36340 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36341 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36342 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36343 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36344 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36345 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36346 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36347 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36349 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36350 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36351 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36356 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36358 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36359 .cindex "envelope from"
36360 .cindex "envelope sender"
36361 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36362 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36363 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36364 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36365 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36366 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36368 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36369 .oindex &%return_path%&
36370 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36371 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36372 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36373 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36374 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36375 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36376 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36382 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36383 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36385 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36386 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36387 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36388 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36389 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36390 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36391 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36394 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36396 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36397 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36398 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36399 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36400 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36401 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36403 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36404 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36405 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36406 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36410 domains = ! +local_domains
36412 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36413 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36416 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36417 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36418 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36419 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36422 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36423 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36424 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36425 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36426 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36430 domains = ! +local_domains
36431 transport = remote_smtp
36433 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36434 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36437 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36438 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36439 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36440 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36443 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36444 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36445 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36446 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36447 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36448 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36456 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36457 .cindex "virtual domains"
36458 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36459 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36463 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36464 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36465 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36467 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36468 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36469 have login accounts on that host.
36472 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36473 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36474 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36475 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36476 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36477 to a router of this form:
36481 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36482 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36485 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36486 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36487 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36488 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36489 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36490 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36492 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36493 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36494 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36495 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36497 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36498 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36499 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36503 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36504 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36505 transport = my_mailboxes
36507 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36508 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36509 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36510 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36511 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36515 driver = appendfile
36516 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36519 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36520 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36522 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36523 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36524 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36525 information about the domains.
36529 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36530 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36531 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36532 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36533 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36534 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36535 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36536 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36537 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36538 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36539 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36540 example, consider this router:
36545 file = $home/.forward
36546 local_part_suffix = -*
36547 local_part_suffix_optional
36550 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36551 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36552 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36553 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36555 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36556 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36559 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36560 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36561 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36562 control over which suffixes are valid.
36564 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36565 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36571 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36572 local_part_suffix = -*
36573 local_part_suffix_optional
36576 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36577 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36578 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36579 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36580 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36584 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36585 .cindex "vacation processing"
36586 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36587 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36588 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36589 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36590 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36593 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36594 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36595 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36596 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36598 spqr, vacation-spqr
36601 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36602 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36603 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36604 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36605 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36609 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36610 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36614 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36615 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36616 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36617 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36618 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36619 each day's messages.
36621 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36622 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36623 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36624 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36628 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36629 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36630 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36631 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36632 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36633 permanently connected.
36635 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36636 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36637 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36640 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36641 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36642 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36643 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36644 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36645 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36646 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36647 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36649 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36650 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36651 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36652 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36653 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36654 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36657 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36658 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36659 intermittent host. For example:
36661 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36663 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36664 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36665 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36666 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36667 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36668 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36671 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36672 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36673 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36674 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36675 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36676 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36677 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36681 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36682 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36683 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36684 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36685 delivered immediately.
36687 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36688 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36689 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36690 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36691 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36692 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36693 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36694 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36695 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36696 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36697 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36698 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36699 single SMTP connection.
36703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36706 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36707 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36708 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36709 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36710 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36711 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36712 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36713 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36714 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36715 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36718 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36719 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36720 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36721 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36722 email is not desirable.
36724 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36725 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36726 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36727 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36728 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36729 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36730 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36732 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36733 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36734 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36735 before sending a message to the smart host.
36737 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36738 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36739 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36741 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36742 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36743 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36744 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36745 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36746 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36747 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36749 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36753 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36754 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36756 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36757 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36758 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36759 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36760 successful, a zero return code is given.
36762 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36763 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36764 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36765 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36766 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36769 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36770 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36771 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36773 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36774 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36775 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36776 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36777 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36779 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36780 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36781 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36783 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36784 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36785 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36786 are ever generated.
36788 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36790 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36791 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36792 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36795 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36796 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36797 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36798 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36799 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36800 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36805 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36808 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36809 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36810 .cindex "log" "types of"
36811 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36816 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36817 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36818 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36819 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36820 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36821 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36822 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36823 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36825 .cindex "reject log"
36826 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36827 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36828 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36829 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36830 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36831 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36832 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36833 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36834 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36837 .cindex "panic log"
36838 .cindex "system log"
36839 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36840 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36841 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36842 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36843 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36844 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36845 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36846 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36847 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36850 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36851 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36852 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36854 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36857 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36858 ways of changing this:
36861 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36866 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36868 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36871 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36875 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36876 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36877 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36878 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36879 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36880 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36885 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36886 .cindex "log" "destination"
36887 .cindex "log" "to file"
36888 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36890 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36891 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36892 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36893 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36894 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36895 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36896 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36898 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36899 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36900 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36901 references to the host name:
36903 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36905 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36906 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36907 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36908 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36909 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36912 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36913 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36914 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36915 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36916 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36917 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36918 implying the use of a default path.
36920 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36921 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36922 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36923 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36924 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36925 equivalent to the setting:
36927 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36929 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36930 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36931 that is where the logs are written.
36933 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36934 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36936 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36938 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36939 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36940 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36941 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36943 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36948 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36949 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36950 .cindex "cycling logs"
36951 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36952 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36953 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36954 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36955 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36956 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36957 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36959 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36960 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36961 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36962 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36963 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36964 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36965 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36966 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36967 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36968 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36969 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36974 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36975 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36976 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36977 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36978 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36979 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36980 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36981 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36983 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36984 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36985 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36986 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36988 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36989 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36991 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36992 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36993 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36994 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36996 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36997 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36998 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36999 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37001 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37002 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37003 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37004 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37005 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37006 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37009 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37010 /var/log/exim-panic.log
37011 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37012 /var/log/exim/panic
37016 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37017 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37018 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37019 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37020 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37021 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37022 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37023 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37024 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37025 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37026 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37027 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37028 the time and host name to each line.
37029 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37032 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37034 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37036 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37039 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37040 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37041 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37042 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37044 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37045 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37046 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37047 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37048 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37049 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37050 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37051 RFC 3164, you should set
37053 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37055 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37056 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37058 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37059 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37060 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37061 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37062 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37063 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37064 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37065 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37066 name, and pid as added by syslog:
37068 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37069 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37070 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37071 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37074 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37077 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37078 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37079 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37080 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37082 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37083 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37084 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37085 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37086 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37087 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37089 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37090 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37091 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37094 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37096 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37097 without modification.
37099 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37100 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37101 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37106 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37107 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37108 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37109 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37110 timestamp. The flags are:
37112 &`<=`& message arrival
37113 &`(=`& message fakereject
37114 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37115 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37116 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37117 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37118 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37119 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37123 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37124 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37125 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37126 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37127 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37129 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37130 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37131 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37133 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37134 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37135 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37139 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37143 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37144 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37145 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37146 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37147 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37148 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37149 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37150 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37151 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37152 name in parentheses.
37154 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37155 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37156 the log containing text like these examples:
37158 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37159 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37161 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37164 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37165 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37168 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37169 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37170 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37171 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37172 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37173 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37174 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37175 suite that was used.
37177 .cindex log protocol
37178 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37179 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37180 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37181 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37182 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37183 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37184 authenticator name.
37186 .cindex "size" "of message"
37187 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37188 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37189 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37190 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37193 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37194 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37198 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37199 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37200 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37201 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37202 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37203 to fit it on the page:
37205 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37206 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37207 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37208 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37209 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37211 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37212 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37213 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37214 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37215 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37217 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37218 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37219 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37220 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37222 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37223 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37225 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37227 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37228 parentheses afterwards.
37230 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37231 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37232 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37233 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37234 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37235 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37236 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37237 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37238 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37239 TLS cipher information is still available.
37241 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37242 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37243 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37244 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37245 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37247 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37248 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37250 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37251 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37254 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37255 .cindex "discarded messages"
37256 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37257 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37258 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37259 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37261 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37262 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37264 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37265 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37267 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37268 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37272 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37273 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37275 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37276 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37278 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37279 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37280 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37282 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37283 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37285 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37286 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37287 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37291 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37292 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37293 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37294 following form is logged:
37296 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37297 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37299 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37300 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37302 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37303 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37304 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37305 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37306 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37308 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37309 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37310 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37311 flagged with &`**`&.
37315 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37316 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37317 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37318 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37319 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37323 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37326 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37328 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37329 at the end of its processing.
37334 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37335 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37336 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37337 the following table:
37339 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37340 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37341 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37342 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37343 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37344 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37345 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37346 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37347 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37348 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37349 &`H `& host name and IP address
37350 &`I `& local interface used
37351 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37352 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37353 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37354 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37355 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37356 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37357 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37358 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37359 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37360 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37361 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37362 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37363 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37364 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37365 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37366 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37367 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37368 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37369 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37370 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37371 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37372 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37376 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37377 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37378 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37381 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37382 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37383 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37384 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37385 during the first delivery attempt.
37387 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37388 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37389 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37391 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37392 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37393 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37394 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37395 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37398 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37399 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37402 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37403 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37405 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37406 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37408 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37409 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37410 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37414 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37417 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37418 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37419 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37426 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37427 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37428 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37429 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37430 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37433 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37435 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37436 selection marked by asterisks:
37438 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37439 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37440 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37441 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37442 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37443 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37444 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37445 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37446 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37447 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37448 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37449 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37450 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37451 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37452 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37453 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37454 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37455 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37456 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37457 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37458 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37459 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37460 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37461 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37462 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37463 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37464 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37465 &` pid `& Exim process id
37466 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37467 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37468 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37469 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37470 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37471 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37472 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37473 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37474 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37475 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37476 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37477 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37478 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37479 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37480 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37481 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37482 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37483 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37484 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37485 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37486 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37487 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37488 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37489 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37490 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37492 &` all `& all of the above
37494 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37495 section &<<SECID99>>&
37497 More details on each of these items follows:
37501 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37502 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37503 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37504 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37505 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37506 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37508 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37509 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37510 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37511 this log selector is set.
37513 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37514 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37515 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37516 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37517 such users cannot access the log).
37519 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37520 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37521 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37522 parentheses between them.
37524 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37525 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37526 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37527 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37528 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37529 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37530 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37531 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37532 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37533 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37534 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37535 between the caller and Exim.
37537 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37538 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37539 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37541 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37542 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37543 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37544 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37545 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37546 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37548 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37549 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37550 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37551 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37552 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37554 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37555 .cindex "size" "of message"
37556 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37557 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37559 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37560 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37561 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37562 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37564 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37565 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37566 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37568 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37569 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37570 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37571 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37572 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37575 .cindex dnssec logging
37576 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37577 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37578 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37579 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37580 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37582 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37583 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37584 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37585 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37586 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37587 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37589 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37590 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37591 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37592 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37593 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37595 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37596 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37597 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37598 client's ident port times out.
37600 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37601 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37602 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37603 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37604 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37605 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37606 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37607 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37608 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37609 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37610 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37612 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37613 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37614 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37615 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37616 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37617 on a proxied connection
37618 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37619 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37621 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37622 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37623 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37624 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37625 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37626 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37627 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37628 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37629 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37630 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37631 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37633 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37634 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37635 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37637 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37638 .cindex millisecond logging
37639 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37640 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37641 appended to the seconds value.
37644 .cindex "log" "message id"
37645 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37647 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37648 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37649 (submission mode) without one.
37650 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37653 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37654 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37655 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37656 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37657 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37658 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37659 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37660 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37661 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37663 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37664 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37665 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37666 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37667 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37668 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37669 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37670 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37671 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37672 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37674 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37675 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37676 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37677 immediately after the time and date.
37679 .cindex log pipelining
37680 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37681 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37682 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37683 The field is a single "L".
37685 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37686 the field has a minus appended.
37689 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37690 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37691 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37692 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37693 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37697 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37698 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37699 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37701 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37702 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37703 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37704 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37705 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37706 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37707 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37708 message has been successfully received.
37709 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37710 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37712 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37713 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37714 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37715 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37717 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37718 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37719 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37720 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37721 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37723 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37724 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37725 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37726 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37727 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37729 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37732 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37733 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37734 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37735 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37737 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37738 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37739 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37740 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37741 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37743 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37744 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37745 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37746 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37749 .cindex "log" "return path"
37750 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37751 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37752 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37753 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37755 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37756 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37757 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37758 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37759 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37761 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37762 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37763 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37764 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37767 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37768 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37771 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37772 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37773 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37774 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37776 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37777 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37779 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37780 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37781 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37782 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37783 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37784 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37787 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37788 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37789 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37790 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37791 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37792 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37793 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37794 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37795 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37796 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37798 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37799 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37800 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37801 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37802 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37803 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37804 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37805 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37807 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37808 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37809 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37810 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37811 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37812 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37814 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37815 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37816 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37817 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37818 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37819 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37820 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37821 already have their own log lines.
37823 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37824 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37825 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37826 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37827 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37828 the same logging options.
37830 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37831 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37835 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37836 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37837 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37838 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37839 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37841 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37842 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37843 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37844 was accepted or used.
37846 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37847 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37848 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37849 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37850 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37851 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37852 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37853 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37855 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37856 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37857 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37858 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37859 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37860 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37861 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37862 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37863 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37865 .cindex "log" "subject"
37866 .cindex "subject, logging"
37867 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37868 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37869 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37870 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37871 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37873 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37875 .cindex DANE logging
37876 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37877 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37879 using a CA trust anchor,
37880 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37881 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37883 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37884 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37885 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37886 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37888 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37889 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37890 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37891 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37892 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37894 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37895 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37896 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37897 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37898 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37900 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37901 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37902 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37906 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37907 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37908 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37909 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37910 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37911 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37912 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37913 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37914 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37915 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37916 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37917 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37918 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37920 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37921 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37922 &%message_logs%& option false.
37928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37931 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37932 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37933 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37934 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37935 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37937 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37938 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37939 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37940 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37941 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37942 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37943 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37945 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37946 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37947 "extract statistics from the log"
37948 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37949 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37950 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37951 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37952 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37953 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37954 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37955 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37958 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37959 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37960 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37965 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37966 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37967 .cindex "process, querying"
37969 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37970 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37971 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37972 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37973 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37974 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37975 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37976 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37978 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37979 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37980 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37983 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37984 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37985 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37986 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37987 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37990 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37991 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37992 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37993 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37995 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37997 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37998 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37999 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38000 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
38001 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
38002 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38004 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38005 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38009 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38010 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38011 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
38012 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38016 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38020 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38021 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38023 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38024 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38027 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38028 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38029 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38033 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38034 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38035 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38037 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38038 Match against the size field.
38040 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38041 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38043 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38044 Match messages that are older than the given time.
38047 Match only frozen messages.
38050 Match only non-frozen messages.
38053 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38054 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38058 The following options control the format of the output:
38062 Display only the count of matching messages.
38065 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38069 Display message ids only.
38072 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38075 Display messages in reverse order.
38078 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38081 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38085 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38086 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38087 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38088 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38089 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38090 running a command such as
38092 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38094 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38095 it, as in the following example:
38097 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38099 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38100 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38101 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38102 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38104 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38105 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38106 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38107 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38108 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38109 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38112 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38113 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38114 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38115 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38116 level"& addresses).
38121 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38123 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38124 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38125 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38126 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38127 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38128 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38129 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38130 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38131 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38132 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38134 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38136 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38138 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38139 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38140 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38142 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38143 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38144 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38145 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38146 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38148 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38149 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38150 regular expression.
38152 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38153 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38155 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38156 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38160 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38161 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38162 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38163 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38164 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38165 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38168 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38169 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38170 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38171 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38172 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38175 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38176 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38177 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38178 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38179 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38180 the &%--help%& option.
38183 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38184 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38185 .cindex "cycling logs"
38186 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38187 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38188 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38189 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38190 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38191 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38192 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38194 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38195 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38197 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38198 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38199 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38203 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38204 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38205 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38206 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38207 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38208 logs are handled similarly.
38210 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38211 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38212 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38213 any existing log files.
38215 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38216 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38217 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38218 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38219 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38221 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38223 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38224 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38228 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38229 .cindex "statistics"
38230 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38231 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38232 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38233 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38234 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38236 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38237 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38238 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38239 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38240 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38242 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38244 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38245 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38246 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38247 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38248 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38249 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38250 also produced per user.
38252 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38253 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38254 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38255 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38256 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38258 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38259 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38260 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38261 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38262 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38263 an entirely separate message.
38265 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38266 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38267 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38268 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38269 least one address that failed.
38271 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38272 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38273 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38274 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38275 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38276 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38277 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38279 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38280 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38281 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38283 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38284 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38285 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38287 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38290 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38291 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38292 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38293 .cindex "checking access"
38294 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38295 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38296 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38297 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38298 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38299 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38301 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38302 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38304 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38306 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38307 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38308 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38309 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38312 550 Relay not permitted
38314 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38315 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38316 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38317 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38320 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38321 -f himself@there.example
38323 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38324 mandatory arguments.
38326 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38327 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38328 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38332 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38333 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38334 .cindex "building DBM files"
38335 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38336 .cindex "lower casing"
38337 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38338 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38339 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38340 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38341 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38342 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38344 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38345 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38346 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38347 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38350 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38351 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38352 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38356 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38357 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38358 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38359 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38361 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38363 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38364 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38366 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38367 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38368 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38369 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38370 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38371 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38373 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38374 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38375 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38376 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38377 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38378 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38379 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38385 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38386 .cindex "retry" "times"
38387 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38388 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38389 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38390 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38391 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38392 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38393 output. For example:
38395 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38396 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38397 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38398 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38399 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38400 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38401 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38402 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38403 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38404 past final cutoff time
38406 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38407 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38408 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38409 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38410 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38411 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38414 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38415 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38416 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38417 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38418 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38419 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38423 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38424 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38425 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38426 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38427 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38428 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38429 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38432 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38434 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38437 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38439 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38441 &'misc'&: other hints data
38444 The &'misc'& database is used for
38447 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38449 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38450 &(smtp)& transport)
38452 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38458 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38459 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38460 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38461 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38462 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38464 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38466 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38468 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38469 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38471 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38472 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38473 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38474 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38475 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38476 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38477 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38478 and a textual description of the error.
38480 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38481 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38482 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38485 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38486 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38487 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38488 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38489 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38490 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38495 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38496 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38497 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38498 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38499 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38500 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38501 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38502 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38503 updated sufficiently often.
38505 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38506 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38507 the retry database:
38509 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38511 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38512 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38513 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38514 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38515 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38516 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38517 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38518 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38519 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38520 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38521 whenever it removes information from the database.
38523 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38524 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38525 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38526 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38527 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38529 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38530 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38531 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38532 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38533 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38534 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38535 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38538 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38539 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38544 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38545 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38546 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38547 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38548 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38549 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38550 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38553 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38554 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38555 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38556 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38557 by new data, for example:
38561 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38562 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38563 used as optional separators.
38568 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38569 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38570 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38571 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38572 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38573 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38574 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38575 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38576 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38577 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38578 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38579 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38580 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38584 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38587 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38590 .vitem &%-interval%&
38591 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38592 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38594 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38595 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38598 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38601 Suppress verification output.
38603 .vitem &%-retries%&
38604 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38605 the lock (default 10).
38607 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38608 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38609 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38610 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38613 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38614 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38615 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38616 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38619 Generate verbose output.
38622 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38623 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38624 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38625 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38626 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38627 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38628 more than 30 minutes old.
38630 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38631 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38632 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38633 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38634 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38635 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38637 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38638 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38639 suppresses all output except error messages.
38643 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38645 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38647 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38648 <&'some commands'&>
38651 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38652 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38655 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38656 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38658 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38659 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38666 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38667 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38668 .cindex "X-windows"
38669 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38670 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38671 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38672 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38673 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38674 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38675 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38676 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38680 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38681 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38682 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38683 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38684 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38685 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38686 parameters are for.
38688 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38689 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38690 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38692 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38694 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38695 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38696 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38697 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38698 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38700 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38701 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38703 Eximon*background: gray94
38705 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38706 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38707 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38708 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38709 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38710 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38711 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38714 Eximon*highlight: gray
38717 .cindex "admin user"
38718 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38719 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38721 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38722 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38723 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38724 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38725 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38727 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38728 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38729 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38730 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38731 different parts of the display.
38736 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38737 .cindex "stripchart"
38738 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38739 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38740 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38741 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38742 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38743 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38744 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38745 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38746 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38748 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38749 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38750 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38751 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38753 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38754 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38755 to a single partition.
38757 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38758 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38759 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38760 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38761 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38762 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38763 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38768 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38769 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38770 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38771 .cindex "window size"
38772 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38773 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38774 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38775 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38776 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38777 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38779 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38780 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38781 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38782 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38784 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38785 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38786 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38787 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38788 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38789 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38791 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38792 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38793 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38797 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38798 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38799 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38800 the main log is maintained.
38801 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38802 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38803 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38804 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38805 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38807 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38808 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38809 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38810 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38811 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38812 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38813 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38814 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38815 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38816 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38817 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38819 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38820 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38821 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38822 It cannot go further back up the log.
38824 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38825 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38826 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38827 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38828 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38829 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38831 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38832 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38833 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38834 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38835 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38836 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38838 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38839 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38840 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38841 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38842 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38843 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38844 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38845 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38846 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38851 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38852 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38853 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38854 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38855 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38856 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38857 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38858 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38859 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38860 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38862 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38863 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38864 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38865 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38866 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38867 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38868 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38870 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38871 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38872 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38873 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38874 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38875 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38876 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38878 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38879 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38880 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38881 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38883 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38884 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38885 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38886 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38887 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38888 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38889 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38892 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38893 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38895 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38896 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38897 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38898 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38899 display is updated.
38903 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38904 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38905 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38906 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38907 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38910 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38911 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38912 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38913 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38914 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38916 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38918 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38922 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38923 in a new text window.
38925 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38926 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38927 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38929 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38930 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38931 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38932 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38934 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38935 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38936 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38937 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38938 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38940 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38941 that the message be frozen.
38943 .cindex "thawing messages"
38944 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38945 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38946 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38947 that the message be thawed.
38949 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38950 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38951 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38952 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38954 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38955 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38958 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38959 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38960 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38961 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38962 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38963 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38964 which case no action is taken.
38966 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38967 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38968 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38969 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38970 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38971 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38972 case no action is taken.
38974 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38975 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38977 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38978 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38979 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38980 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38981 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38982 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38983 the address is qualified with that domain.
38986 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38987 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38988 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38989 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38990 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38991 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38992 if no output is generated.
38994 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38995 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38996 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38997 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38999 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39000 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39001 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39008 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39011 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39012 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39013 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39014 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39016 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39017 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39018 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39019 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39020 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39021 its security as compared with other MTAs.
39023 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39024 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39025 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39026 as soon as possible.
39029 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39030 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
39031 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39032 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39033 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39034 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39037 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39038 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39039 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39040 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39041 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39042 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39044 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39045 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39046 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39047 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39050 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39051 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39052 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39053 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39054 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39055 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39056 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39057 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39058 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39062 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39063 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39064 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39065 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39066 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39067 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39068 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39070 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39073 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39074 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39075 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39076 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39077 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39082 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39084 .cindex "root privilege"
39085 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39086 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39087 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39088 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39089 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39090 is required for two things:
39093 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39094 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39097 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39098 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39102 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39103 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39104 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39105 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39106 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39107 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39108 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39109 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39111 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39112 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39113 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39115 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39116 uid and gid in the following cases:
39121 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39122 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39123 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39124 the calling process.
39125 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39126 option may not be used at all.
39127 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39128 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39129 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39134 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39135 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39138 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39139 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39140 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39141 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39142 testing address verification
39145 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39148 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39149 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39152 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39155 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39156 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39157 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39158 will be used during message reception.
39160 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39161 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39163 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39164 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39165 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39166 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39167 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39168 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39169 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39170 generating bounce and warning messages.
39172 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39173 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39174 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39175 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39177 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39178 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39184 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39185 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39186 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39187 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39188 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39189 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39190 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39191 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39192 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39193 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39197 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39198 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39199 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39200 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39202 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39203 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39204 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39205 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39206 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39208 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39209 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39210 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39213 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39214 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39215 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39217 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39218 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39219 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39220 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39221 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39222 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39223 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39224 address this problem at this time.
39226 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39227 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39228 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39229 be used in the most straightforward way.
39231 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39232 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39235 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39236 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39237 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39238 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39239 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39241 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39242 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39244 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39245 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39246 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39247 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39249 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39250 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39253 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39254 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39255 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39257 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39258 owned by the Exim user.
39260 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39261 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39262 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39267 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39268 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39269 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39270 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39272 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39273 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39278 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39279 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39280 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39284 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39285 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39286 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39287 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39288 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39289 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39290 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39293 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39294 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39295 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39296 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39297 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39299 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39300 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39301 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39302 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39303 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39304 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39305 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39307 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39308 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39309 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39311 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39312 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39314 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39315 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39316 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39318 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39319 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39320 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39322 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39323 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39324 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39325 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39331 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39332 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39333 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39334 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39335 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39336 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39337 are some issues to be aware of:
39340 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39342 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39344 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39345 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39346 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39347 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39348 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39349 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39352 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39353 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39354 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39356 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39357 expected to yield one result.
39363 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39364 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39365 .cindex "IP source routing"
39366 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39367 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39368 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39369 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39373 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39374 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39375 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39380 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39381 .cindex "trusted users"
39382 .cindex "admin user"
39383 .cindex "privileged user"
39384 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39385 .cindex "user" "admin"
39386 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39387 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39388 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39389 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39390 permit a remote host to be specified.
39393 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39394 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39395 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39396 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39397 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39398 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39400 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39401 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39402 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39403 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39404 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39406 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39407 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39408 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39409 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39410 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39414 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39415 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39416 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39417 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39418 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39419 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39421 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39422 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39423 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39424 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39425 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39426 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39429 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39430 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39431 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39432 This affects most of the checking options,
39433 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39436 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39437 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39438 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39439 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39440 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39441 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39445 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39446 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39447 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39448 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39449 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39454 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39455 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39456 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39457 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39462 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39463 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39464 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39465 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39466 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39470 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39471 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39472 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39476 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39477 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39478 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39479 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39480 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39481 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39482 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39484 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39485 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39490 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39491 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39492 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39493 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39497 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39498 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39499 enough to hold the result.
39500 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39508 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39509 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39510 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39511 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39512 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39513 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39514 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39515 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39516 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39517 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39518 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39519 themselves are recoverable.
39521 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39522 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39523 and should not be used as such.
39525 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39526 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39527 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39530 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39531 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39532 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39533 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39534 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39536 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39537 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39538 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39539 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39541 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39543 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39546 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39548 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39549 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39550 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39551 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39552 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39553 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39554 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39555 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39558 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39559 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39560 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39561 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39563 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39564 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39565 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39566 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39567 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39568 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39569 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39570 normally the Exim user.
39572 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39573 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39574 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39575 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39576 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39577 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39578 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39579 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39581 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39582 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39583 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39584 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39586 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39587 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39590 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39591 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39592 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39593 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39594 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39595 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39596 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39597 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39598 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39601 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39602 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39603 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39604 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39605 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39606 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39608 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39609 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39610 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39611 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39612 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39613 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39615 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39616 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39617 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39619 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39620 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39621 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39622 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39623 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39625 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39626 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39627 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39628 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39629 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39631 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39632 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39633 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39635 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39636 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39637 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39639 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39640 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39641 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39643 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39644 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39645 present if the number is greater than zero.
39647 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39648 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39649 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39651 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39652 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39653 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39655 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39656 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39659 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39660 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39661 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39664 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39665 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39666 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39667 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39669 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39670 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39671 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39673 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39674 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39675 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39676 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39677 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39678 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39680 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39681 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39682 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39683 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39684 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39686 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39687 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39688 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39689 generated messages.
39692 The message is from a local sender.
39694 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39695 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39697 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39698 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39699 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39700 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39702 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39703 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39704 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39707 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39708 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39711 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39712 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39713 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39715 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39716 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39717 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39719 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39720 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39721 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39723 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39724 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39725 rather than Unix-format.
39726 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39727 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39729 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39730 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39731 certificate was verified by the server.
39733 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39734 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39735 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39737 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39738 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39739 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39744 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39745 corresponding data is untrusted.
39748 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39749 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39750 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39751 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39752 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39753 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39754 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39755 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39756 addresses are complete.
39758 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39759 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39760 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39761 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39762 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39763 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39765 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39766 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39767 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39769 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39770 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39771 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39772 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39776 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39777 darcy@austen.fict.example
39779 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39781 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39782 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39783 line is of the following form:
39785 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39786 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39788 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39789 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39790 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39791 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39792 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39793 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39794 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39795 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39798 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39799 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39800 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39801 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39802 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39806 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39807 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39808 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39809 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39810 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39811 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39812 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39813 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39814 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39815 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39818 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39819 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39820 typical set of headers:
39822 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39823 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39824 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39825 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39826 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39827 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39828 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39829 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39830 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39831 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39832 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39834 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39835 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39836 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39837 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39838 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39839 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39841 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39842 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39843 an ASCII newline character.
39844 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39845 can have an alternate format.
39846 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39847 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39848 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39849 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39850 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39851 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39853 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39854 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39856 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39857 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39859 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39862 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39863 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39864 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39865 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39867 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39868 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39869 any original DKIM signature.
39871 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39872 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39874 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39876 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39877 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39878 (including transport filters)
39879 except cutthrough delivery.
39881 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39882 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39883 different signature contexts.
39886 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39887 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39888 Exim's standard controls.
39890 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39891 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39893 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39894 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39895 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39896 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39898 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39899 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39900 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39901 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39904 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39905 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39906 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39907 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39911 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39912 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39914 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39915 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39917 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39919 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39920 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39923 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39924 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39925 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39926 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39927 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39929 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39930 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39932 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39933 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39934 After expansion, this can be a list.
39935 Each element in turn,
39939 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39940 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39941 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39942 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39944 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39945 This sets the key selector string.
39946 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39947 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39948 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39949 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39950 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39951 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39953 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39954 This sets the private key to use.
39955 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39956 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39957 The result can either
39959 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39961 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39962 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39964 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39967 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39968 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39972 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39974 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39975 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39977 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39978 for the DNS TXT record.
39979 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39983 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39984 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39987 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39989 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39990 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39994 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39996 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39997 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39998 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39999 for some transition period.
40000 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40003 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40005 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40006 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40009 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40011 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40012 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40016 Exim also supports an alternate format
40017 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40018 of the standard, but not adopted.
40019 A future release will probably drop that support.
40022 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40023 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40025 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40027 &`sha256`& &-- the default
40029 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40032 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40034 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40037 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40038 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40039 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40040 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40041 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40042 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40044 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40045 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40046 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40047 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40048 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40050 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40051 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40052 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40053 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40054 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40057 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40058 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40059 list of header names.
40060 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40061 in the message signature.
40062 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40063 whether or not each header is present in the message.
40064 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40065 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40067 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40068 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40069 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40071 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40072 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40074 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40075 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40076 name will be appended.
40078 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40079 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40080 If not set, no such information will be included.
40081 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40083 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40084 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40086 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40089 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40090 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40092 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40093 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40095 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40096 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40097 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40098 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40099 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40102 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40103 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40104 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40107 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40108 of this section can be ignored.
40111 The results of verification are made available to the
40112 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40113 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40114 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40115 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40116 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40117 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40118 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40120 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40121 a large number of expansion variables
40122 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40123 runtime of the ACL.
40125 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40126 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40127 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40128 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40130 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40131 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40132 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40133 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40134 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40135 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40138 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40140 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40141 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40142 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40144 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40146 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40147 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40148 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40150 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40153 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40154 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40157 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40158 (such as the From: header)
40159 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40160 and for the domain part if identities.
40161 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40164 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40165 for each matching signature.
40168 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40169 available (from most to least important):
40173 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40174 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40175 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40176 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40178 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40179 Within the DKIM ACL,
40180 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40182 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40183 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40185 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40186 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40188 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40189 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40191 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40194 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40195 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40196 hash-method or key-size:
40198 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40199 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40200 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40201 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40202 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40203 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40204 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40207 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40208 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40209 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40210 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40212 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40213 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40214 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40216 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40217 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40219 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40220 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40222 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40223 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40224 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40226 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40227 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40228 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40229 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40232 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40234 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40235 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40236 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40237 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40239 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40240 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40241 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40242 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40244 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40245 The key record selector string.
40247 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40248 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40249 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40250 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40251 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40254 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40256 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40258 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40259 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40262 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40263 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40265 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40266 processing of such signatures.
40269 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40270 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40272 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40273 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40275 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40276 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40277 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40278 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40279 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40280 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40282 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40283 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40284 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40285 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40286 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40287 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40288 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40289 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40291 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40292 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40293 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40295 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40296 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40297 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40298 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40299 integer size comparisons against this value.
40300 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40302 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40303 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40305 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40306 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40308 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40309 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40311 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40312 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40315 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40316 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40319 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40320 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40322 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40323 Number of bits in the key.
40325 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40327 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40328 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40331 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40332 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40333 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40337 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40340 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40341 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40342 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40343 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40344 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40347 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40348 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40349 sender_domains = gmail.com
40350 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40354 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40355 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40357 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40358 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40359 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40360 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40363 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40364 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40365 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40366 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40369 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40370 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40371 for more information of what they mean.
40377 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40378 .cindex SPF verification
40380 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40381 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40382 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40383 the &url(http://openspf.org).
40384 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40385 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40386 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40389 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40390 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40392 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40393 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40394 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40395 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40396 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40398 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40399 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40400 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40401 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40404 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40405 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40406 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40407 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40408 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40412 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40415 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40416 domain in the envelope-from address.
40418 .vitem &%softfail%&
40419 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40423 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40426 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40427 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40428 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40430 .vitem &%permerror%&
40431 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40432 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40434 .vitem &%temperror%&
40435 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40436 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40439 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40440 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40441 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40442 short-circuit fashion.
40447 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40448 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40449 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40450 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40451 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40452 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40453 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40454 ip=$sender_host_address
40457 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40460 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40462 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40463 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40464 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40465 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40466 it for logging purposes.
40468 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40469 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40470 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40471 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40472 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40473 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40475 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40476 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40478 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40479 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40480 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40481 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40484 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40485 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40486 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40487 and required in order to obtain a result.
40489 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40490 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40491 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40492 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40496 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40497 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40498 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40499 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40500 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40501 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40503 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40504 for a description of what it means.
40505 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40507 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40508 of the spf one. For example:
40511 deny spf_guess = fail
40512 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40515 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40516 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40517 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40520 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40521 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40523 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40524 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40525 &%spf_guess%& option.
40526 For example, the following:
40529 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40532 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40535 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40537 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40538 address as the key and an IP address
40545 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40548 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40549 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40556 .section DMARC SECDMARC
40557 .cindex DMARC verification
40559 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40560 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40561 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40562 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40563 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40565 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40566 the libopendmarc library is used.
40568 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40569 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40570 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite rpm package
40571 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40572 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40573 This description assumes
40574 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40575 are in /usr/local/lib.
40579 There are three main-configuration options:
40580 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40582 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40583 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40584 defines the location of a text file of valid
40585 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40586 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40587 the most current version can be downloaded
40588 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/, currently pointing
40589 at https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat)
40590 See also util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40591 The default for the option is /etc/exim/opendmarc.tlds.
40594 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40595 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40596 defines the location of a file to log results
40597 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40598 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40599 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40600 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40601 directory of this file is writable by the user
40603 The default is unset.
40605 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40606 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40607 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40608 forensic report detailing alignment failures
40609 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40610 and you have configured Exim to send them.
40611 If set, this is expanded and used for the
40612 From: header line; the address is extracted
40613 from it and used for the envelope from.
40614 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40615 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40618 . I wish we had subsections...
40620 .cindex DMARC controls
40621 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40622 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40623 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40624 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40625 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40626 DMARC with a control setting:
40628 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40630 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40631 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40632 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40633 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40634 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40635 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40636 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40637 exim will send these forensic emails. It's also advised that you
40638 configure a dmarc_forensic_sender because the default sender address
40639 construction might be inadequate.
40641 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40643 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40644 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40645 your exim config. If you don't tell it to send them, it will not
40648 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40653 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40654 "dmarc_status" ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40655 call the "spf" condition first in the ACLs, then the "dmarc_status"
40656 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40657 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40658 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40659 occurs until a "dmarc_status" condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40661 The dmarc_status condition takes a list of strings on its
40662 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40663 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40664 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40666 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40667 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40668 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40669 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40670 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40671 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40672 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40673 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40675 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40676 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40677 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40678 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40679 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40680 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40683 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40684 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40685 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40687 Performing the check sets up information used by the
40688 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40690 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40691 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40692 expansion variables are available:
40695 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40696 .cindex DMARC result
40697 is a one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40698 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40699 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40700 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40701 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40703 &$dmarc_status_text$&
40704 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40705 is a slightly longer, human readable status.
40707 &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40708 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40709 is the domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40711 &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40712 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40713 is the policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40714 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40715 is any error, including no DMARC record.
40719 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40720 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40721 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40722 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40723 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40724 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40725 processing or failure delivery issues).
40727 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40728 tools, you need to:
40730 Configure the global setting dmarc_history_file
40732 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40733 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40736 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40738 Configure the global setting dmarc_forensic_sender
40740 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40741 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40749 warn domains = +local_domains
40750 hosts = +local_hosts
40751 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40753 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40754 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40756 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40757 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40760 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40762 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40764 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40766 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40768 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40770 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40771 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40773 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40774 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40775 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40777 deny dmarc_status = reject
40779 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40781 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40792 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40794 .cindex "proxy support"
40795 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40797 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40798 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40801 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40802 .cindex proxy inbound
40803 .cindex proxy "server side"
40804 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40805 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40807 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40808 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40809 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40812 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40813 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40815 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40816 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40817 to distribute load.
40818 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40819 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40820 There is no logging if a host passes or
40821 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40822 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40824 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40825 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40826 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40827 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40828 automatically determines which version is in use.
40830 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40831 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40832 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40833 Exim and the proxy server.
40835 The following expansion variables are usable
40836 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40839 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40840 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40841 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40842 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40843 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40845 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40846 there was a protocol error.
40847 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40848 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40850 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40851 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40852 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40853 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40854 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40855 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40856 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40857 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40858 A possible solution is:
40860 # Set max number of connections per host
40862 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40863 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40865 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40866 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40871 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40872 .cindex proxy outbound
40873 .cindex proxy "client side"
40874 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40875 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40876 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40877 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40878 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40881 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40882 on an smtp transport.
40883 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40884 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40885 Each proxy specifier is a list
40886 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40887 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40889 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40890 The list of options is in the following table:
40892 &'auth '& authentication method
40893 &'name '& authentication username
40894 &'pass '& authentication password
40896 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40898 &'weight '& selection bias
40901 More details on each of these options follows:
40904 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40905 .cindex proxy authentication
40906 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40907 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40908 for access to the proxy.
40909 Default is &"none"&.
40911 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40914 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40917 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40920 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40923 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40924 higher values being tried first.
40925 The default priority is 1.
40927 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40928 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40929 weighted by this value.
40930 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40933 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40934 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40935 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40937 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40938 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40939 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40940 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40945 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40946 "Internationalisation""
40947 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40950 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40952 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40953 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40954 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40956 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40957 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40958 requirement, upon libidn2.
40960 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40961 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40962 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40963 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40964 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40965 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40967 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40968 international handling for the message is enabled and
40969 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40971 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40972 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40973 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40974 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40976 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40977 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40978 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40979 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40981 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40982 components expanded to a-label form,
40983 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40986 .cindex log protocol
40987 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40988 .cindex i18n logging
40989 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40990 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40992 The following expansion operators can be used:
40994 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40995 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40996 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40997 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41000 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41001 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41003 may use the following modifier:
41005 control = utf8_downconvert
41006 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41008 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41009 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41010 Message Submission Agent context.
41011 If a value is appended it may be:
41013 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41014 &`0 `& no downconversion
41015 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41018 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41019 is initially set to -1.
41021 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41022 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41023 and it overrides any previously set value.
41026 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41027 Configurations supporting these should inspect
41028 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41030 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41031 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41032 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41034 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41035 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41039 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41040 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41041 the following expansion operator can be used:
41043 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41046 The string is converted from the charset specified by
41047 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41048 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41050 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41051 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41052 (which has to be a single character)
41053 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41054 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41056 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41057 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41059 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41060 by many other IMAP servers.
41064 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41065 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41066 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41069 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41070 must be representable in UTF-16.
41073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41076 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41080 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41081 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41082 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41083 processing actions.
41085 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41086 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41087 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41089 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41090 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41091 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41093 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41094 An example might look like:
41095 .cindex logging custom
41097 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41098 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41099 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41100 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41101 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41102 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41103 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41104 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41105 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41109 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41110 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41111 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41114 The current list of events is:
41117 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41118 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41119 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41120 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41121 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41122 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
41123 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41124 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41125 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41126 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41127 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41128 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41129 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41131 New event types may be added in future.
41133 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41134 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41135 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41137 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41138 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41139 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41141 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41142 should define the event action.
41144 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41145 with the event type:
41147 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41148 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41149 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41150 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41151 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41152 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41153 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41154 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41155 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41156 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41159 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41161 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41162 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41163 the course of its processing:
41165 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41168 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41169 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41171 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41172 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41174 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41175 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41176 following will be forced:
41178 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41179 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41180 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41182 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41183 no other use is made of it.
41185 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41186 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41189 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41190 chain element received on the connection.
41191 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41197 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41198 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41199 .cindex "adding drivers"
41200 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41201 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41202 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41203 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41206 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41207 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41209 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41211 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41213 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41214 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41215 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41217 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41219 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41222 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41223 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41225 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41226 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41227 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41228 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41229 simple form that most lookups have.
41231 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41232 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41233 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41235 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41236 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41238 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41241 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41242 as for other drivers and lookups.
41245 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41246 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41247 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41248 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41249 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41251 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41252 the interface that is expected.
41257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41260 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41261 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41262 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41263 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41265 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41270 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41271 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41275 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41276 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41277 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41280 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41281 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////